This is only a preview of the July 2009 issue of Silicon Chip. You can view 33 of the 104 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments. For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues. Items relevant to "Lead-Acid Battery Zapper & Desulphator Mk.3":
Items relevant to "Hand-Held Metal Locator":
Items relevant to "Multi-Function Active Filter Module":
Items relevant to "High-Current, High-Voltage Battery Capacity Meter, Pt.2":
Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00. |
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 1
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.jaycar.com.au
Contents
Vol.22, No.7; July 2009
www.siliconchip.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
Features
12 The Magic Of Water Desalination
The driest continent on Earth is about to get much more drinking water from
the sea, thanks to new desalination plants. Here’s a look at how they work
– by Geoff Graham
The Magic Of Water
Desalination – Page 12.
20 Review: Two Low-Cost DVD Recorders
Thinking of retiring that ancient VCR and getting a DVD recorder? Here’s a
look at two low-cost units: the Tevion DD1018 & the AWA DR711 – by Barrie
Smith
Lead-Acid
Battery Zapper
& Desulphator
Mk.3 – Page 26.
78 CeBIT: What’s New At Australia’s Largest IT Show?
There’s lots to see at CeBIT. We took a stroll around the displays to bring you
this report – by Ross Tester
Pro jects To Build
26 Lead-Acid Battery Zapper & Desulphator Mk.3
Rejuvenate old lead-acid batteries by zapping them with high-voltage pulses
to dissolve the lead-sulphate crystals on their plates. It works with 6V, 12V &
24V batteries & is easy to build – by Jim Rowe
38 Hand-Held Metal Locator
Compact unit is ideal for finding steel frames & studs, steel bracing & nails in
plaster walls. And it can discriminate between ferrous and non-ferrous metals
– by John Clarke
58 Multi-Function Active Filter Module
Versatile design is ideal for use as an active crossover in loudspeaker systems
but has other uses as well. It can be configured as a low-pass filter, as a highpass filter or as a bandpass filter using on-board jumpers – by John Clarke
80 High-Current, High-Voltage Battery Capacity Meter, Pt.2
Hand-Held
Metal Locator
– Page 38
This month, we guide you through the once-only setup and calibration
procedure. We also tell you how to use it – by Mauro Grassi
Special Columns
70 Circuit Notebook
(1) RF Preamplifier For World-Band Receivers; (2) Signal Inverter Runs From
5V Rail; (3) Simple Water Spillage Alarm; (4) Accurate Timer Locked To 50Hz
Mains Supply; (5) Enhanced Software For The Appliance Energy Meter
44 Serviceman’s Log
Car electronics: a whole new ballgame – by the Serviceman
89 Vintage Radio
The Lyric 8-Valve Console From The 1920s – by Rodney Champness
Departments
2
4
19
37
Publisher’s Letter
Mailbag
Subscriptions
Order Form
siliconchip.com.au
57
96
99
102
Product Showcase
Ask Silicon Chip
Notes & Errata
Market Centre
Multi-Function Active
Filter Module – Page 58.
July 2009 1
SILICON
SILIC
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Publisher & Editor-in-Chief
Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD
Production Manager
Greg Swain, B.Sc. (Hons.)
Technical Editor
John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.)
Technical Staff
Ross Tester
Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc
Mauro Grassi, B.Sc. (Hons), Ph.D
Photography
Ross Tester
Reader Services
Ann Morris
Advertising Enquiries
Glyn Smith
Phone (02) 9939 3295
Mobile 0431 792 293
glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au
Regular Contributors
Brendan Akhurst
Rodney Champness, VK3UG
Mike Sheriff, B.Sc, VK2YFK
Stan Swan
SILICON CHIP is published 12 times
a year by Silicon Chip Publications
Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49
003 205 490. All material is copyright ©. No part of this publication
may be reproduced without the written consent of the publisher.
Printing: Hannanprint, Noble Park,
Victoria.
Distribution: Network Distribution
Company.
Subscription rates: $94.50 per year
in Australia. For overseas rates, see
the order form in this issue.
Editorial office:
Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Postal address: PO Box 139,
Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
Phone (02) 9939 3295.
Fax (02) 9939 2648.
E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
ISSN 1030-2662
* Recommended and maximum price only.
2 Silicon Chip
Publisher’s Letter
Natural gas means
geosequestration is unnecessary
My “Publisher’s Letter” last month poured scorn
on “carbon pollution” and geosequestration, which
is now known as “Carbon Capture & Storage Technology”. As you might expect, there has been significant
criticism of that viewpoint but considerable support
as well.
Coincidentally, David Knox, CEO of Santos, has
put the case for using natural gas to fire Australia’s
thermal power stations, some 80% of which are currently coal-fired.
As he points out, “if we are serious about confronting climate change, and
if we are to deliver the Government’s target of a 60 percent reduction in carbon emission by 2050, we need to reduce the carbon intensity of Australia’s
baseload power generation”. He goes on to state “that gas fired power technology (known as combined cycle or CCGT) emits only 40 percent of the carbon
emissions of the existing” average coal-fired power station. In fact, it already
delivers 80 percent of the carbon reduction hoped for from geosequestration.
Now David Knox could be dismissed as simply selling his wares but he is
nonetheless correct. He also highlights the peak load ability (as well as base
load) of gas-fired stations and their greatly reduced use of water compared to
coal-fired stations. In fact, a gas-fired power station only uses 1% of the water
required for a coal-fired station. I am not referring to the water required for
cooling but to the water required for coal scrubbing.
He could have added that the extraction of natural gas causes none of the
problems of damage to water resources by coal mining. Nor does it cause
subsidence as in the case of long-wall mining or have the need for extremely
costly landscape remediation, as in the case of open-cut mining.
Nor does a gas-fired station produce huge quantities of ash which must
also be disposed of. The more you think about it, using Australia’s massive
gas deposits for electricity generation is a very good idea.
You can read the full text of the Santos submission to the Australian Government’s energy white paper process on the Santos website at http://www.
santos.com/Archive/NewsDetail.aspx?p=121&id=1145
Not only is using natural gas for power stations more environmentally
friendly, it is thermodynamically much more efficient, particularly when
employed in “combined cycle”. This is where the hot exhaust from the gas
turbines is used to generate steam and run a turbo-alternator. The net result
is that gas-fired power stations not only emit less carbon dioxide than coalfired stations, they produce far less emissions than would be produced with
a coal-fired power station which was using some sort of (yet to be proven)
carbon capture and storage system.
So rather than introducing an elaborate and expensive emissions trading
scheme (ETS), the government should be seriously contemplating converting Australia’s existing coal-fired power stations to gas. And if it cannot do it
for the black coal stations, it should certainly do it for the brown coal power
stations in Victoria. Admittedly the conversion process will be expensive
but it will be much cheaper and easier to implement than the proposed ETS.
Furthermore, it could be done easily over the next 10 years or so.
Leo Simpson
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 3
MAILBAG
Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters to
the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and has the
right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to submissions
to “Ask SILICON CHIP” and “Circuit Notebook”.
Earthing for TV
distribution system
We recently had a room added to
the house which then required a TV
outlet. This and the purchase of an HD
LCD TV prompted me to replace the
motley collection of cable and splitters
in my distribution system, which over
the years had grown from the original
single point to five. I rewired in RG6
cable with F connectors and cast alloy
splitters. The improvement in reception is amazing.
One of the old splitters had failed on
one output and the 5-year old Akai TV
in that room had used a “rabbits ears”
antenna. When I connected this to the
Electronic anti-fouling
I am the owner of a yacht which
needs anti-fouling to be applied each
year to take care of growth on the
hull, as does every other pleasure
craft. This is expensive but importantly, anti-fouling compounds pollute the marine environment.
Recently, a system has been developed which employs one or two
ultrasonic transducers attached to
the inside of the hull. This system
effectively prevents growth from
attaching to the hull. This can save
boat owners annual bills of over
$2000.
Now here is the rub: the marketers
charge over $5000 for the kit to do
my yacht, justifying the price by how
much it could save me over time. I
have no doubt you could design such
4 Silicon Chip
new system, we had 50Hz hum on all
radios in the house. When I unplugged
the fly lead from the wall socket I felt
a tingle when I touched the shroud.
I measured the voltage to earth with
my Fluke DMM and it was 110VAC. As
it could supply no current, the source
was obviously high impedance. I have
not had time the look at the TV yet to
find the cause but it made me think
about the lack of any earthing on the
antenna system.
In the days before live chassis,
switchmode supplies and 2-pin mains
plugs, the shield on the antenna cable
was earthed by its connection to the
earthed chassis. Now the whole system
a unit at a fraction of the cost if you
put your minds to it.
This could be of interest to many
boat owners who are also into
electronics. These units are not yet
mass-produced in China and so
prices are not reduced accordingly,
allowing the “merchants” to employ
demand-driven pricing and so make
super profits at the expense of “early
adopters”.
This is where SILICON CHIP comes
in. Could you run this as a project
in your magazine?
Anthony Willis,
Koolewong, NSW.
Comment: we are very interested in
the electronic anti-fouling concept.
In the meantime, we are publishing
your letter to see if we can get reader
feedback on whether it really works.
floats above earth so that if a fault connects it to a dangerous voltage, there is
no path to cause a protective device,
fuse, circuit breaker etc, to operate.
I am planning to connect the metal
housing of one of the splitters to my
house protective earth, so as to provide
this path.
Phil Andrews,
Adelaide, SA.
Comment: you would be better off
earthing the whole system where
the cable connects to the antenna.
Earth the antenna as well. A separate
grounding stake is desirable. This
will also improve noise immunity on
digital TV reception.
Possible flaw in
GPS-Synchronised Clock
With regard to the GPS-Synchronised Clock in the March 2009 issue,
surely the fatal flaw is that the GPS
receiver won’t be able to pick up
satellites anywhere indoors. My relatively modern GPS receivers (a Garmin
hand-held and Garmin car unit) don’t
have a hope of getting satellite signal
anywhere in my house where I would
want a clock. Am I missing something?
Mark Stephens,
Brisbane, Qld.
Comment: the recommended EM-408
GPS module is extremely sensitive. It
works fine in our building which has
a steel roof. Even better, it continues
to work when placed in a steel filing
cabinet!
siliconchip.com.au
I refer to the new “Dead-Accurate 6-Digit GPSLocked Clock” in the May 2009 issue. Knowing that
the NMEA 0183 data stream arrives about 250ms
after its appropriate PPS and that the clock is not
referenced to the PPS, I’m curious as to what the
clock is actually referenced to.
I believe the update of the display will be around
250ms late. This is hardly “dead accurate”.
Trevor Dalziell,
Calwell, ACT.
Comment: you are quite correct: there will be a
fixed delay of about 250ms between the updated
time and “actual” GPS time. There is nothing that
can be done about this and anyone building either
of our GPS-synchronised clocks will need to resign
themselves to being forever 250ms behind real time.
GPS-Synchronised Clock
web page
I have been getting a lot of email on the GPS-Synchronised Clock project so I built a web page with hints
and notes to help constructors. It also contains a new
version of the firmware which corrected one issue and
added some additional features. You can find the page
at http://geoffg.net/GPS_Synchronised_Clock.html
I thought that you could point people to it if they
need help.
Geoffrey R. Graham,
Perth, WA.
Great Value in Test & Measurement
GPS synchronised clock is delayed
siliconchip.com.au
The NEW 350MHz 2/4 Channel
Digital Oscilloscope
HMO3522/3524
4GSa/s Real time,
50GSa/s Random sampling,
low noise flash A/D converter
(reference class)
2MPts memory per channel,
memory Zoom up to 100,000:1
MSO (Mixed Signal Opt. HO3508)
with 8/16 logic channels
EV conversion was a beauty
I would like to compliment SILICON CHIP on presenting its readers with such a delightful smorgasbord of
articles and projects as we have seen these last couple of months. If I had to single out one article that I
found particularly enjoyable, it would have to be the
one describing Malcolm Faed’s conversion of a Hilux
ute to all-electric drive (June 2009). Without question
Malcolm deserves to be congratulated for his splendid
efforts. How nice it is to see such initiative displayed
in an Oz setting.
I also liked the article on the battery monitor project
in the same issue. There really has been a need for such
a project for quite some time. I haven’t as yet had time
to fully digest all the good features but from a quick
overview this monitor is definitely the sort of thing
that every critical battery-operated appliance should
be teamed with.
As the article points out, batteries are expensive. If
I may add to that statement, usually by far the most
expensive single component in battery-operated equipment is the battery. Not only do high-capacity batteries
contribute a significant part of the initial cost of new
equipment, they can represent a very high proportion
of the maintenance costs, particularly if the battery
charge and discharge cycles are not properly monitored
(and controlled), resulting in shortened battery life.
On odd occasions, I have been asked to repair vari-
Analog meets Digital
Sensitivity
Vertical sensitivity 1mV...5V/div.
(into 1MΩ/50Ω)
Offset control ±0,2...±20V
Trigger modes: slope, video,
pulsewidth, logic, delayed, event
Accuracy
FFT for spectral analysis
6 digit counter, Autoset, automeasurement, formula editor
Lowest noise fan
Quality
Simplicity
Crisp 6.5” LED backlit VGA display,
12div. x-axis display range
20div. y-axis with virtual screen
function, DVI output
3 x USB for mass storage, printer
and remote ctrl.
optional IEEE-488 or
Ethernet/USB
Rohde & Schwarz (Australia) Pty Ltd
Unit 2, 75 Epping Road, North Ryde, NSW 2113
sales.australia<at>rohde-schwarz.com
July 2009 5
Mailbag: continued
More water vapour
than carbon dioxide
Your recent Global Warming essay (Publisher’s Letter, June 2009)
is interesting but you will need to
revise your basic stoichiometry
if you are to pass this year’s HSC
Chemistry exam.
You did correctly balance your
equation but if you burn two moles
(228 grams) of octane with 25 moles
(800 grams) of oxygen and “calculate
the molecular weights” as you were
taught in your chemistry class you
would have correctly shown that 704
grams of CO2 and 324 grams H2O
would be produced.
The reaction does make more
moles of water vapour than CO2 and
so the gas volume of water vapour
is greater than the gas volume of the
CO2 but you cannot really say that
“there is more water produced than
carbon dioxide”.
Leo will need to work on biology
revision as well. Yes, CO2 is needed
for photosynthesis and in a greenhouse increasing the concentration
of CO2 will allow the “plants to grow
more vigorously”. What you don’t
mention is that in most natural ecosystems, particularly in Australia, it
is water availability that acts as the
limiting factor for photosynthesis,
not the CO2 level. Even in aquatic
ecosystems where there is high water availability, the extra CO2 from
ous kinds of electronically-operated
equipment for a non-profit community
project that provides low-cost scooters
for the elderly and disabled. Far too
often have I seen what should have
been perfectly good batteries ruined
by improper charging (either too much
or not enough) or by the batteries being run to their limits before they are
recharged.
I lay at least part of the blame on
the design of the scooters in certain
cases, particularly in the case of older
machines, which allows the machines
to continue running even when the
batteries are on the point of exhaustion. Another nag is that some designs
employ what users might easily be
6 Silicon Chip
burning fossil fuels will probably do
more damage than good, as it lowers
the pH when it dissolves in water.
This pH change will reduce the efficiency of enzymes important in
photosynthesis and other reactions.
Leo correctly argues that geosequestration is an expensive and
energy-inefficient fantasy designed
to allow us to keep mining and exporting coal.
We do not “really know if global
warming is wholly or partially
caused by human activity” but we
must do everything possible, just
in case. I am sure that you would
not consider buying a car without
seatbelts and airbags just because no
one had proved that you were going
to have an accident.
Dave Dobeson,
Berowra Heights, NSW.
Comment: the Publisher’s Letter
should have alluded to the fact
that the volume of water vapour
produced is more – not the mass.
However, the main purpose was
to point out that it is not carbon
pollution that is the problem and
that water vapour is a major combustion product of the burning of
fossil fuels. Carbon dioxide may be
a problem but we still don’t know
whether human activity is the main
cause of the current warming cycle
or if indeed, the warming cycle has
actually ended.
misled to believe are state-of-charge
displays but are in fact nothing more
than glorified voltmeters.
Of course, when batteries, particularly of the lead-acid kind, are fully
charged they usually give a significantly higher terminal voltage than
when partially or fully discharged.
Such displays can be used as rough
and ready guides to the state of battery
charge provided that the batteries are
not heavily loaded. But as you know,
every battery, together with any connecting cables, presents a resistance
in series with a load.
So if you put a voltmeter across
the load or even directly across the
battery, in an attempt to measure the
siliconchip.com.au
state of charge of the battery you would be very much
disappointed, because the increased voltage drop across
load (or battery terminals) due to the series resistance
causes the apparent state-of-charge indication to be less
than the true state of charge of the battery.
An obvious solution is to replace the voltmeter type
display with an intelligent one that, in addition to
battery voltage, also monitors the charge put into and
drawn from a battery and, in addition, compensates for
the voltage drop across any series resistance, to give a
more reliable indication of state of charge.
As a passing thought, some constructors might like to
see a scaled-down version of the project; one with, say,
just the PC board plus essential on-board components
and maybe a bit of extra software programmability (if
necessary) to make it easy for someone to integrate the
monitor into existing equipment.
Another article that I would like to mention is the 10A
Motor Speed Controller featured in the May 2009 issue.
I particularly liked the idea of sensing the motor current,
rather than back-EMF, to control the speed (I wish I had
thought of it). There are a couple of questions I would
like to ask regarding this controller:
(1) Would it be possible to adapt the speed controller,
without too much modification, to enable variable torque
limiting?
(2) Would the speed controller work with the load on
the AC side of the bridge rectifier rather than on the DC
side as it is now?
Herman Nacinovich,
Gulgong, NSW.
Comment: with regards to your questions concerning the
230V/10A controller, it may well be possible to use the
circuit as a torque controller for a particular motor but
operating the load on the AC side of the bridge rectifier
is problematic as the MOSFET loading arrangements
would need to be changed.
Response to Publishers’ Letter
on global warming
With reference to your editorial on global warming
in the June 2009 issue, a more correct term is climate
change as it actually reflects what is happening.
You focused on carbon dioxide as one of the so-called
greenhouse gases but the two primary gases are methane
and water vapour. These are very important as they help
keep the temperature of the surface of the earth within
a liveable (for life as we know it) range.
As long as there is a balance between the creation
and absorption and destruction of these gases, then the
amount of energy radiated from the Earth matches the
amount received from the Sun. If this balance changes,
the result will be climate change.
The concept that this will be a general warming is very
simplistic. What is actually happening is there is more
energy being input into the atmosphere. You mentioned
that the concept was just chemistry. No, this is physics, specifically atmospheric physics which is based on
thermodynamics.
The adding of more energy into the atmosphere does
siliconchip.com.au
ADVANCED BATTERY TESTER
MBT-2LA
Features
Computes State of Charge for lead acid battery types
(SLA, AGM, Gel, Flooded)
Test battery condition – quickly and easily identifies
weak or failing batteries
Patented high accuracy Pulse Load test – battery safe,
non-invasive
Test 2-volt, 4-volt, 6,volt, 8-volt, 12-volt
Measures battery performance under load, not just
voltage or internal resistance
Ideal for battery management & cell matching –
reduce costs and increase reliability
Description
The MBT-LA2 provides a comprehensive means of testing the state of
charge and battery condition for 2-volt, 4-volt, 6,volt, 8-volt and 12-volt
lead acid battery types (SLA, AGM, Gel, Wet). Lightweight, compact
design make it an ideal tool for anyone working with lead acid batteries.
The microprocessor-controlled instrument tests popular batteries
using a patented, high-accuracy pulse load tests. After a fully automatic
test cycle, percentage of remaining battery capacity is indicated on the
LED bar display. Test results are easy to understand. An integrated
cooling fan dissipates heat from testing, and the circuit is protected
against over-voltage. Rugged NBR rubber sleeve protects against
impact. Includes 48" removeable test leads with sold copper clamps.
The accessory kit (K-MBTLA2) includes a hanging strap & magnet for
hands-free operation, and a protective soft case. Requires 4AA
batteries (not included).
Applications
ŸFire/security
ŸUPS
ŸMedical
ŸIndustrial
ŸLighting
ŸTelecom
ŸMobility
ŸInspection
ŸMilitary
ŸSafety
ŸService
ŸIT
ŸAccess control
ŸAuto/marine/RV
ŸManufacturing
ŸUtilities
For more information, contact
SIOMAR BATTERY
INDUSTRIES
(08) 9302 5444 or mark<at>siomar.com
July 2009 7
Mailbag: continued
not mean a general warming. An
example is the lighting of a fire in a
fireplace in a house. The immediate
area is warmed but the rest of the
house will cool down as cold air is
drawn in to replace the air drawn up
the chimney, so if you average out the
whole temperature in the house it may
actually show a drop.
The additional energy in the atmosphere will show as an increase in
the frequency and severity of weather
events such as cyclones; it will also
cause a shift in weather patterns such
as the monsoon, El Nino and La Nina,
which in turn can cause excessive
precipitation in one area and drought
in another.
It will be interesting to see over the
next few years how the Caribbean
& Gulf of Mexico hurricane seasons
shape up; will there be an increase in
the number of category 5 storms? Will
this be matched with a similar increase
in the Bay of Bengal?
8 Silicon Chip
As you mentioned, CO2 is absorbed
by plants. The problem we have is not
only are we emitting more, we are also
clearing the forests that would be active in the absorption process.
The concept that the excess CO2
can be dissolved in the ocean might
work but this would slightly increase
its acidity, which has the potential
to affect anything that uses calcium
carbonate as a shell or skeleton.
It is very easy to deny climate
change but by the time it becomes
totally obvious it will be too late.
How many 1-in-100 year events will
it take to prove it exists? The first sign
will probably be from the insurance
industry, as they will be watching the
increased number of claims.
Laurens Meyer,
Richmond, Vic.
Leo Simpson comments: you have
drawn conclusions from my editorial
which are not justified. Carbon dioxide
and “carbon pollution” is what politi-
cians and environmentalists are focussing on. They are essentially ignoring
methane and water vapour although
the proposed Australian Emissions
Trading Scheme will penalise graziers
because their sheep and cattle emit
methane. This is insane!
I was focussing on the burning of
fossil fuels, not the existence or causes
of methane.
If you want more authoritative
information on whether climate
change is caused by human activity,
you need to read Ian Plimer’s book
entitled “Heaven & Earth; The Missing
Science”. He does not deny climate
change and nor do I. I just don’t think
that humans have anything to do with
it. The energy produced and used by
humans may seem incredibly large but
it is vanishingly small when compared
to the total energy input from the Sun.
Even a very slight variation in solar
output will completely overwhelm
anything that humans do. The Sun’s
output does vary significantly and
does have a major effect. Consider the
Mediaeval Warming and the Little Ice
siliconchip.com.au
Age and other major global climate
variations which have occurred in the
last 2000 years and right back to the
beginning. Man’s presence has had
no effect.
Disputing the
Publisher’s Letter
At the risk of seeming “hysterical”,
Leo Simpson’s Publisher’s Letter in
the June 2009 issue cannot go without comment. Leo attempts to give us
a simple chemistry lesson and then
to use that to berate those ignorant
“greenies”.
The first problem is his lesson is
wrong. The equation in his letter
(2C8H18 + 25O2 => 16CO2 + 18H2O)
means that by mass (ie, calculating the
weights as asked) 16 * (12 +(16*2)) =
704 grams of CO2 are emitted vs 18 *
(1*2 + 16) = 324 grams of water (I’ve
rounded the numbers).
Leo then makes the false and irrelevant comment that the mass of
water being released from combustion
is more than the mass of CO2 and that
therefore CO2 is not a problem. This
is equivalent to saying we only need
to know one property of electrical
components when deciding their importance OR function.
Water is the most significant greenhouse gas in the atmosphere. Those
greenies called atmospheric scientists
are well aware of this. But the global
atmospheric water balance is largely
unaffected by direct human action and
is dominated by the dynamic equilibrium between solar-driven evaporationtranspiration and precipitation. The
average lifetime of a water molecule
in the atmosphere, where the bulk of
the water is below the stratosphere,
Reaction to Puppy Linux
I’m an old IT buff, pretty up to
speed on Windows but I was very
attracted to try your Puppy Linux
installation in the March 2009 issue.
I have a Sony Vaio PCG-R600
which was my main laptop for a
few years, since replaced by a much
faster Toshiba. Everything in the
Sony was working but WinXP had
slowed down incredibly, in spite of
all the tweaks and scrubs of several
maintenance programs.
So I followed your instructions
to the letter. I downloaded the latest version of Puppy on my BIG
desktop, burned the CD with your
recommended ISO file burner and
tried to boot the Sony with the CD.
Nothing! After searching for hours
I finally found a clue: install hangs
with SATA CD drives, not with IDE
CD drives. I then used an outboard
CD drive, which got me further down
the track. However the install still
hung. There is a work-around by
putting the three vital Linux files
on a thumb drive and completing
the boot from there.
So, very elated in spite of the huge
frustrations with the SATA drive, I
decided to install the HD boot option
and chose “Frugal” install. All went
well until I got to GUMP. Making
the changes to the GUMP execute
is eight days. Carbon dioxide has an
atmospheric lifetime of decades.
I shouldn’t need to point out that
CO2 and H2O, being different molecules, unsurprisingly have different
infrared spectra (http://en.wikipedia.
org/wiki/File:Atmospheric_Trans-
text file felt like changing something
in WIN registry, so I checked and
double-checked before hitting “return” at each input.
My Linux partition was sda5 so I
was careful to input the correct drive
and partition details. Everything
completed and I re-booted the PC
from the HD.
Boom, end of story, the “Kernel /
puppy400/vmlinuz pmedia=idehd
psubdir=puppy400” hung with
“file not found”. I went back and
changed every possible parameter
(pmedia=satahd, idecd, sata cd, you
name it) but no luck.
And I’m STUCK in GUMP – no
way to go back to the BIOS program,
no way to get back into Puppy, I
am GUMPED for life! I searched for
further hours and hours on the posts,
Puppy search etc. Nothing!
So I’m afraid that my experience
has been a complete waste of two
days’ time. Next move? Wipe the HD
and do an XP reinstall. And forget
about Linux (again – I tried a couple
of years ago with similar results).
Mate, if it installs without hiccups, it’s brilliant but once you get
into the Linux coding side, it isn’t
for the faint-hearted!
John Nixon,
Optical Network Engineering,
Auckland, NZ.
mission.png). We use this property
in instruments to measure one in the
presence of the other and it is this same
property (in conjunction with the mass
and lifetime) that is important when
we determine the relative greenhouse
effect of the two. In the link above we
You wear multiple hats. Shouldn’t your scope?
The new Agilent Infiniium 9000 Series
oscilloscopes are engineered for
broadest measurement capability. You
never know what your next project
will require. That’s why we designed
the new Infiniium 9000 Series to be
as versatile as you need to be.
Agilent Infinium 9000 Series Oscilloscopes
Bandwidth: 1GHz, 2.5GHz, 4GHz
Channels: 4 analog + 16 digital on MSOs
Sample rate:10GSa/s
Memory: 10M --1G
Display:
15" XGA
Footprint: 33 x 43 x 23mm (h x w x d); 11.8kg
Phone: 1800 629 485 View online demo at www.agilent.com/find/9000family
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 9
Mailbag: continued
see that the spectra for CO2 fills in
some absorption gaps for water.
Leo also made the true but irrelevant comment that water and carbon
dioxide are both essential to life; the
implication being that they are therefore harmless. This is like saying that
since voltage and current are essential
for the functioning of a circuit, we can
ignore the danger imposed by 1kV <at>
1A, as we all know that 1V <at> 10mA
is “harmless”. The dose makes the
poison. Another element that is essential to life is selenium but only at
trace amounts: swallow a gram or two
and you will suffer.
The argument is frequently put that
more CO2 means plants grow better.
This may be true in a greenhouse but
in the real world it means more than
that. Photosynthesis comes in several
flavours and different plants have different mechanisms (C3, C4 & CAM) for
taking up CO2 – the initial step. Thus
some plant species may be favoured
over others. But, the so-called CO2
fertilisation effect also depends on
temperature, nutrients and water.
Increases in temperature can remove any benefit from the increased
CO2 concentrations. Climate zones
can move but soils do not. If climate
zones do move, will they fortuitously
align with regions of high soil fertility?
And what of water – a question very
pertinent to Australia?
Moving on to the statement “Nor do
we really know if global warming is
wholly or partially caused by human
activity”. This is the Plimer argument.
If the increase in CO2 concentration
was the only evidence at hand, one
could argue for other sources of that
CO2. But we also have the isotopic
signatures of carbon that comes from
volcanoes, carbon that comes from
fossil fuels and the carbon in the atmosphere. On top of that, we also have
measurements of the O2 concentrations – which are falling in line with
the carbon increases thus suggesting
combustion. How do volcanic emissions of CO2 reduce O2 levels? The
evidence is clear. It’s “us wot done it”.
Even if you dispute that increased
levels of CO2 don’t automatically mean
the temperature will increase like
Svante Arrhenius (a notable chemist and apparently a greenie before
his time) suggested, another issue is
the decrease in the oceanic pH that
increased levels of CO2 are causing! A
mixed blessing. For while the oceans
continue to absorb CO2 it slows the rate
of increase in the atmosphere – but at
the expense of the ability of shell fish
and corals to create their shells.
One day the oceans will no longer
absorb as much CO2 and then the
trouble really starts – that’s not being
hysterical, it’s a statement of chemical fact. We know the constants that
describe oceanic equilibria.
While I agree with Leo’s scepticism
of Carbon Capture and Storage (it’s
a sop to the coal mining industry),
articles and letters like this devalue
the magazine. I suggest either consultation with real experts in the
field or the purchase of an excellent
reference like “Earth System Science:
From Biogeochemical Cycles to Global
Change”. Anything by frustrated mining geologists near retirement should
be returned to the remaindered bin.
Am I hysterical?
Shane Perryman,
Margate, Tasmania.
Comment: if you have a look at the
volumes of gases released in the
combustion of octane, there is more
water vapour than carbon dioxide.
In any case, carbon pollution is not
the problem. Maybe we do have a
problem with carbon dioxide but that
is still unknown. Doubling the “dose”
of carbon dioxide probably won’t have
catastrophic effects.
You cannot simply reject an argument because it has been put forward
by Ian Plimer (and others). He could
well be correct or he might be wrong
– we don’t know at this stage. Do you
dispute the previous warming cycles
when man had nothing to with it?
Australia’s Best Value Scopes!
Shop
On-Line
at
emona.com.au
GW GDS-1022 25MHz
RIGOL DS-1052E 50MHz
RIGOL DS-1102E 100MHz
25MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
250MS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device & SD Card Slot
50MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge
100MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge
Sydney
Brisbane
Perth
ONLY $599 inc GST
Melbourne
Tel 02 9519 3933
Tel 03 9889 0427
Fax 02 9550 1378
Fax 03 9889 0715
email testinst<at>emona.com.au
10 Silicon Chip
ONLY $879 inc GST
Tel 07 3275 2183
Fax 07 3275 2196
Adelaide
Tel 08 8363 5733
Fax 08 8363 5799
ONLY $1,169 inc GST
Tel 08 9361 4200
Fax 08 9361 4300
web www.emona.com.au
EMONA
siliconchip.com.au
CHINA
PCB Supplier
Confusion over
Freeview digital TV
using yellow (video) red (R audio)
and white (L audio) RCA connections into a simple video switch.
I’ve been listening to media pubAll of this involved some nifty inlicity on the introduction of digital
stallation techniques, such as housTV but the information given raises
ing the projector in a wall cavity with
more confusion; for example, “look
the lens aperture normally masked
for the Government sticker on set
by a framed print which slides across
top boxes.” Presumably, that means
on a track. The projected image
the designated boxes1are
compatible
-layer up to 30-layer
might be standard definition and
with whatever. Anything else is
Cost and quality I could worry about HDMI leads
incompatible?
time
deliveryand the like but I am enormously
I made an enquiryOn
to the
“Digital
impressed with the quality of the
TV Task Force” regarding
a new service
SD
Dedicated
picture on this large 2.5-metre screen
set-top box which I purchased in
Online Quote
& Order
and the
sound is great too!
haste some time ago Instant
- now residing
...........DayBrian
and Night
Graham,
in a cupboard, unused. The purchase
was made just priorOto
neconnecting
piece orders are wvia
elcemail.
ome!
to Foxtel cable TV, of course with
Check our low price anComment:
d save big $right
$$ now there are only
three extra digital channels with diftheir own box. But when digital TV
ferent programming to the existing
arrives, why not connect this SD box
SD (and analog) channels: ABC2,
to our old CRT TV set, forgoing the
SBS2 and Ten’s One HD. Most
wonders of HD (which I may have
programs on ABC2 are repeats of
trouble in distinguishing anyway,
shows on ABC1 but there are some
because of deteriorating eyesight)?
worthwhile additional programs to
I am getting little sense out of the
be seen. SBS2 has only just started
“Digital TV Task Force”
have
web:and
www.pcbcore.com
broadcasting and will have a mixsuggested to them email:
that theysales<at>pcbcore.com
should
ture of sport and other programprepare advisory information to
phone: enquiry
86(571)86795686
ming. One HD is great if you like
cover the sort of (dumb?)
lots of sport.
I made. I would guess there would
Later on, there will be a children’s
be millions of Australians who are
TV channel called ABC3. Some time
equally confused. This information
later there might be a couple of othshould be the subject of a national
ers. There certainly will not be 15
letterbox drop, prior to introduction
extra channels although there is a
of the new TV format.
selection of data channels which
However, to be more practical, it
carry low-resolution video.
occurs to me that perhaps SILICON
You need a HD set top box if you
CHIP is preparing an article to do
want to watch HD channels on your
exactly what I had suggested to the
analog TV. Unless you have a large
Task Force. This material should be
HD TV or a HD projector and very
valuable help for many.
keen eyesight, you are unlikely to
While all of this wonderful technotice any difference between HD
nology is advancing on us, I’ve built
and SD broadcasts. Both HD and SD
my own (invisible!) home cinema in
broadcasts do have a big advantage
my living room, with a video projecin that they eliminate noise and
tor and a large pull-down screen.
ghosting in the picture.
This is very simply coupled to my
We agree with your comments
video source (DVD/VCR player,
about projectors and large screens.
cable TV, free-to air or whatever)
For overall impact, a video projector
and (prior to 5.1 surround sound) a
cannot be beaten.
simple stereo sound system, simply
.
.
.
.
.
AWA 893P portable
transistor radio
prototype thru
production
I suppose you have already been
notified but just in case, the radio
featured in this month’s Vintage article
(June 2009) is definitely an AWA 893P
not a 693P. The number can be plainly
siliconchip.com.au
seen in the interior pictures. I have
two of these and I am very pleased
with them.
See my website at http://transistor.
bigpondhosting.com/awa_893p.html
Ian Malcolm,
SC
Scoresby, Vic.
CHINA
PCB Supplier
prototype thru
production
. 1-layer up to 30-layer
. Cost and quality
. On time delivery
. Dedicated service
. Instant Online Quote & Order
...........Day and Night
One piece orders are welcome!
Check our low price and save big $$$
web: www.pcbcore.com
email: sales<at>pcbcore.com
phone: 86(571)86795686
AMALGEN
TECHNOLOGIES PTY LTD
the most experienced
Toroidal Transformer
manufacturers in Australia
Manufacturers of the original
ILP Unirange Toroidal Transformer
- in stock from 15VA to 1000VA
- virtually anything made to order!
- UPS, power conditioning and
surge suppression too
Amalgen Technologies Pty Ltd
Ph: (02) 9570 2855 Fax: (02) 9580 5128
email: sales<at>amalgen.com.au
web: www.amalgen.com.au
July 2009 11
The Magic of
What do Perth, Saudi Arabia and cruise ships
have in common? They all rely on desalination
for fresh water. And the Gold Coast, Sydney and
Adelaide are about to join the club!
by Geoff Graham
T
urning salty water into fresh,
drinkable water is not new. In
the early Australian gold rush
days large areas of woodlands were
stripped to feed “condensers” that
boiled salty water and trapped the
condensation for sale to thirsty miners.
These days a large cruise ship will
generate over a million litres of water
a day from the sea using either flash
evaporators or reverse osmosis, while
Middle East countries such as Saudi
Arabia produce over 70% of their
drinking water using various forms
of desalination.
Australia is not left out. The advent
of a drying climate has triggered a
flurry of desalination plants either
planned or under construction with
the first in Perth, Western Australia,
running since 2006.
There are a number of technologies
used for desalination but most modern
large scale plants are based on reverse
osmosis.
These plants are expensive to build
but, in the longer term, cheaper to
run. This technology is quite recent
– it only got its start in the 1970s and
1980s when efficient reverse osmosis
membranes were first manufactured
in quantity.
In Australia
Small desalination plants have been
operating across Australia for many
years, providing drinking water for
towns such as Penneshaw, Coober
Pedy and Marion Bay in South Australia.
The new plants on the drawing
boards are on a much larger scale and
represent a major infrastructure investment. In total six plants are running
or currently planned. All are destined
Fig.1: the layout of a typical desalination plant. It looks simple – salt water is filtered and passed through the reverse
osmosis process. However, as with most things, the reality is more complex with the magic happening in the reverse
osmosis section. (courtesy Sydney Water)
12 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
DESALINATION
Part of a $2 billion project, this aerial picture (taken in March 2009)
shows the Sydney Desalination Plant, currently under construction at Kurnell.
It is now more than 80% complete, with mechanical and electrical work well
underway and will become operational this coming summer.
(courtesy Sydney Water)
to serve major population centres and
will supply a significant amount of our
water needs.
The first was a plant at Kwinana,
south of Perth, built three years ago
for the WA government by a French
consortium. A similar plant, built by
another French consortium, has just
been completed on the Gold Coast.
Sydney is not far behind with a
monster plant nearing completion at
Kurnell that is planned to supply 15%
of the city’s water requirements.
Others preparing for construction
include a second plant for Perth and
the first plant for Adelaide, at Pt Stanvac, both of which will be built by
separate Spanish consortiums.
Finally, Victoria is in the early planning stage for an installation on the
Bass Coast near Wonthaggi.
Desalination is not cheap. The
Perth plant cost $387 million to build
in 2006 while the Sydney plant is
expected to cost almost $2 billion,
including the connecting pipeline.
The amount of water produced is
large by any measure. The Perth plant
produces 130 million litres a day while
Sydney is projected to produce 250
siliconchip.com.au
million litres of water each day.
A typical plant
On paper a desalination plant looks
relatively simple. You suck seawater
in, filter it to remove sand etc and
then pass it through reverse osmosis
membranes to obtain your clean water.
As always, the complications lie in
the details.
The inlet system is where the process starts. Typically a plant will suck
in 20 million litres of water an hour
through large concrete intakes on the
Fig.2: osmosis occurs when water
migrates through a permeable
membrane towards the more salty
solution. The level on the less salty
side will then decrease.
seabed. This is an enormous amount
of water and you might think that it
could also suck in fish and other ocean
life, even including someone who was
enjoying a cooling dip.
This cannot happen because the
inlets have grates across them and are
designed with a very large intake area
to keep the flow to less than 0.1 metre
per second. At this rate the flow is less
than a typical ocean current and does
not affect marine life which can swim
around the inlets as normal.
The water then goes through screen-
Fig.3: reverse osmosis occurs when
pressure is applied to the salty
solution forcing the water through
the membrane to the less salty side.
July 2009 13
ing and filtration stages to remove
sand, algae and similar impurities.
The technology varies but typically,
as in the case of the Perth desalination
plant, sand filters are used. These are
a similar technique to the sand filter
used in a home swimming pool.
All this is normal technology but
the water then enters the high-tech
reverse osmosis section where the
magic begins.
Reverse osmosis
Reverse osmosis can be best explained by looking at the phenomenon
of osmosis first, then explaining the
reverse part.
Osmosis is the ability of water to migrate through a permeable membrane
while leaving dissolved components
behind. This can be observed with two
solutions, one saline and the other not,
separated by a suitable membrane. By
osmosis the water will move slowly
through the membrane from the less
saline solution to the more salty solution.
Contrary to what you might first assume, this action will raise the level
of the salty water above the level of
the less salty solution (see Fig.2).
Membranes are common in nature;
your skin is a membrane and water
will move through it via osmosis while
you are sitting in the bath.
Reverse osmosis, as implied in its
name, is the reverse of osmosis and
occurs when you force the water
through the membrane in the opposite
direction as shown in Fig 3.
The pressure applied to the salty
side must first overcome the tendency
of the water to move via osmosis to the
salty side. Then, with increasing pressure, the water will reverse direction
towards the less saline side leaving
the salt behind in the increasingly
saline solution.
Special membrane
This process requires a special
type of membrane that is permeable
to water but not dissolved salts. It is
Reverse Osmosis pressure vessels. Each contains seven reverse osmosis
membranes tightly wound in coils. The pressure used to force the water through
the membranes is vey high, up to 1000 psi. At this pressure salt water is very
corrosive so high quality stainless steel is used (courtesy Water Corporation WA).
tempting to think of the membrane as
a fine filter which traps larger particles
(salt) while letting water through - but
that is not correct.
The osmosis mechanism is not fully
understood but one explanation is that
the water works its way through the
membrane by packing into an ice-like
A Serendipitous Discovery
In 1959 Sidney Loeb was researching for his master’s thesis with
Srinivasa Sourirajan when together they discovered the first practical membrane for reverse osmosis. That discovery is credited with
being the foundation of modern desalination technology.
While working on membranes in their laboratory they hit upon
a formula which was an unexpected success in that it allowed a
practical flow of water while stopping most salt.
14 Silicon Chip
structure (at room temperature) and
“melting” away on the other side.
The ions from the salt cannot fit into
the ice-like matrix and get left behind.
Unlike a filter, in osmosis it is not the
membrane pore size or the particle
size that matters.
Osmosis itself was first observed
But a second test (from the same sheet of membrane) did not
work. Subsequent tests were either good or bad “as if flipping a
coin” according to Dr Loeb.
Finally they figured out that the membrane was anisotropic (directionally dependent). The side facing the air when the membrane
was cast on a glass plate had to be installed in contact with the
saline solution to work correctly.
In Dr Loeb’s words, “I sometimes wonder if I would have continued
testing that membrane sheet if the first test had been a failure.”
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.4: the construction of a reverse osmosis module.
The clean water permeates through the membrane and
collects in the centre while the water that does not pass
through (the concentrate) carries away the salt and other
impurities. (courtesy Water Corporation WA)
250 years ago and since then researchers experimented with reverse
osmosis.
Despite these efforts, reverse osmosis remained a curiosity because the
water flow through the membrane was
so low that the process was impractical for large scale use. The breakthrough came in 1959 when Sidney
Loeb and Srinivasa Sourirajan in the
USA discovered a membrane that was
much more efficient (see the sidebar
A Serendipitous Discovery).
The modern membrane used in reverse osmosis is a wonder of materials
science and is normally a thin-film,
composite membrane consisting of a
thin polymer barrier layer formed on
one or more porous support layers.
Membranes have different characteristics and it is common for desalination
plants to need two stages of reverse
osmosis to remove everything. For
Fig.5: this diagram
better shows the
flow of water to the
centre of the
membrane coil.
The outer porous
layer allows the
salt water to flow
over the surface of
the membrane.
Water that passes
through the
membrane then
flows via the inner
porous layer to the
centre where it is drained.
(courtesy Water Corporation WA)
example, the first stage will remove
salt while the second targets boron or
in some cases, bromide.
The pressure vessel
The membranes sheets are wound
into large rolls held inside pressure
vessels. These vessels are the long
(generally white) tubes that you see in
a photo of a typical desalination plant.
Inside a pressure vessel the sheets
of membrane are rolled up (see Fig.4)
with the desalinated water (permeate) collecting in the central spine.
At least half of the intake water does
not go through the membrane but
instead runs out and is eventually
discharged back into the sea. It is this
flow of discarded water across the
membranes that keeps them clean and
prevents them from clogging up as a
sieve would.
As shown in Fig.5, the membrane
A sea water intake. A desalination plant can suck up to 20 million litres per
hour but the design of the intakes ensures that the flow into the intake is mild
enough to have little effect on marine life (including divers!).
(courtesy Water Corporation WA)
siliconchip.com.au
spiral is separated by a porous material that allows the seawater to contact
every part of the membrane with an
inner porous layer allowing the clean
water (permeate) to flow to the centre.
A pressure vessel would hold a
number of these rolled membrane
sheets and a typical plant would use
almost 20,000 membranes at a cost of
about $1,000 each. Nothing in desalination is cheap.
Long Term Trend
You would have to be a hermit or living overseas, if you did not know that
Australia is in a prolonged period of
drought. Falling rainfall levels and rising
water consumption across Australia have
reduced the level of water in our dams
and forced our politicians into making
some expensive decisions.
The trend is most apparent in Western
Australia where the inflow of water to
Perth’s dams has been steadily falling
over the past 50 years to one third of
the previously typical levels. To make it
worse, demand has increased by three
times during this same period.
Perth introduced its first water restrictions in 1960 and tapped into other
sources such as groundwater but the
trend has been inexorable. Three years
ago the state government built Australia’s
first desalination plant, the largest of its
kind in the southern hemisphere and now
a second plant for Perth is about to start
construction.
Sydney and Melbourne felt the effects
of the big dry later but their dam levels
have also been steadily falling since 1998.
With traditional sources of water such
as new dams being ruled out for environmental and other reasons planners
across the country are turning to desalination.
July 2009 15
This installation uses six high pressure centrifugal pumps drawing 2600kW each and pumping 1144 cubic metres/hour.
They are made from super duplex stainless steel and need to be very well balanced during installation. Manufacturer was
Clyde Pumps in Scotland. (courtesy Water Corporation)
Recycle Instead?
Another approach to the crisis is to
recycle water. The technology used in
recycling is similar to desalination –
you filter the water to remove the big
stuff and then use reverse osmosis
to remove everything else.
In planning for the Sydney desalination plant Sydney Water made a detailed comparison of the two systems
and the differences are instructive.
The cost of building identical capacity
plants was about 50% higher for the
recycling plant with the running costs
also more expensive.
This makes sense if you think about
it. Both desalination and recycling
take in dirty water and clean it but
recycled water is dirtier and needs
more cleaning. Also, salty water
is easier to get; you just suck it in
from the ocean, whereas water for
recycling must be piped from the
sewage plants.
Apart from the cost, it is difficult to
sell the notion of recycled water to
the public, so it is no wonder that the
planners chose desalination.
16 Silicon Chip
Due to the spiral construction the
membrane does not rupture under
pressure but rather is slowly compressed. It is this compression which
limits the life of a membrane which
is about five to seven years. During
its lifetime the performance of each
membrane is monitored by measuring
the flow rate and testing the quality
of the desalinated water. Membranes
are also cleaned two to three times a
year using caustic, acid and detergent
solutions.
Practical issues
The principle of reverse osmosis
works well, but implementing it in a
plant that must produce millions of
litres a day is not easy.
To force water through the membrane enormous pressures are required. In the Perth desalination plant
there are six large centrifugal pumps
which move millions of litres an hour
at pressures up to 70 bar or in layman’s
terms, about 1000 psi.
These are made from super duplex
stainless steel and must be very well
balanced during installation to cope
with the high speeds involved. Each
consumes 2600kW, enough electricity
to power hundreds of homes (see the
sidebar Where Does the Electricity
Come From?).
The energy used to drive the pumps
is a large part of the cost of running
a plant, and for this reason a lot of
attention is paid to energy efficiency.
The water that passes through the
membranes loses its pressure on the
way through. However, the salty water destined for discharge retains the
high input pressure and rather than
let that energy go to waste, a modern
desalination plant tries to recover as
much as it can.
The technique used in many plants
is called isobaric or “pressure-equalising” energy recovery. This technology
works by allowing the high pressure
water to directly contact and push
against the incoming water in pressure
equalising or “isobaric” chambers.
These chambers are inside spinning
rotors that limit the contact time to
avoid mixing; the result is a stream of
high speed hammer blows against the
incoming stream that transfer most of
siliconchip.com.au
Isobaric or “pressure-equalising”
energy recovery devices. These
transfer the energy contained in the
discharge water to the incoming water
and can reduce energy consumption
by up to 96%. Inside each cylinder
is a high speed spinning rotor made
from tough ceramic that allows the
outgoing water to hammer against the
incoming water and thereby transfer
the energy.
(courtesy Water Corporation)
The only time it will be stopped is
for maintenance and environmental
reasons (for example, the salty outflow is not dispersing). Even in these
circumstances the plant maintains a
small output by continuously rotating a small production through each
bank of membranes to prevent a full
shutdown being forced on them.
Discharge
the energy held in the outgoing stream.
The energy recovery can be as high
as 96% although in practice the actual
percentage is rather lower. Regardless,
this efficiency makes a huge difference
in the amount of electricity required
to drive the high pressure pumps and
therefore the plant’s running costs.
Another issue in plant design is
corrosion. As anyone with a boat
knows, sea water is very corrosive and
at the high pressures used for reverse
osmosis, it is positively destructive.
As a result high grade stainless steel
and ceramics are used in many places
and this is part of the high price tag of
a desalination plant.
Starting and stopping a plant can
take some time (up to a day) and the
membranes need special preservation arrangements to prevent damage
when not being used. Accordingly,
the engineers like to keep the plant
running continuously at full capacity.
The water discharged from the plant
is about double the normal salinity of
sea water and this could be a problem
for marine life if it was simply dumped
back into the sea. Some sites, such as
the Gold Coast and Sydney, can rely on
strong ocean currents to help disperse
the salty water but other locations are
not so convenient.
For example, the Perth plant discharges into Cockburn Sound which
does not have strong currents. Because
of this the outlets were designed to
Where Does the Electricity Come From?
Former NSW Premier, Bob Carr, once famously dismissed the
whole idea of desalination as “bottled electricity”. Desalination
can be thought of as:
salt water + electricity = drinking water
On average it takes about 5kWh of electricity to produce one
thousand litres of fresh water. For plants producing millions of
litres this adds up to a lot of electricity.
As we do not want to compound the environmental effects that
are blamed on burning fossil fuels, renewable energy is a popular
source for the electricity. Consequently Perth, Sydney and others
have decided to go with wind farms.
As with the renewable electricity that you can purchase at home,
the electricity for desalination is drawn from the general power
grid. However, it is purchased at a higher than normal price, even
if the wind farm is becalmed at that time. The extra money is then
paid to the wind farm when they do generate some electricity and
feed it into the grid, as that means that less power is required to be
generated from fossil fuel. The result is the same as transmitting
the power directly to the desalination plant but avoids the cost of
building a duplicate transmission system.
The Perth desalination plant has a continuous power draw of
24MW and this is nominally supplied by the Emu Down Wind Farm
located 100km north of the city. This facility cost $180 million
siliconchip.com.au
to build and has 48 wind turbines capable of generating a peak
80MW of power. 40MW of that is reserved for the desalination
plant which, given the variability of wind power, means that the
desalination plant will end up paying for the equivalent of 24MW
of continuous renewable energy.
For the Sydney desalination plant a wind farm will be built at
Bungendore (near Canberra), with a capacity of 140MW. The
second desalination plant for Perth will go one step further with
20% of its power to come from what is called “speculative energy
sources”. This covers technologies such as geothermal, wave
power and other experimental sources and accordingly an even
higher price will be paid for this electricity.
July 2009 17
sources of water (such as dams) on
days of light water consumption to
favour water from the desalination
plant. In extreme cases they will even
pump the desalinated water into dams
for storage.
As the overall aim of the desalination plant is to conserve the water in
our dams this arrangement will even
out in the long term.
In the unlikely event that the dams
approach overflow the desalination
plant would then be shut down, probably for a long time.
The overall cost of desalinated water
can vary considerably, depending on
many factors, but it is still affordable.
When constructed the Perth plant had
running costs of about $20 million per
year and the cost of water produced
was close to $1.20 per kilolitre.
This can be compared to the cost of
water from traditional sources at the
time of 80c to 90c per kilolitre. Other
plants currently under construction
have projected production costs that
range from $1 to $3 per kilolitre. If you
are in a serious situation like Adelaide,
even that price is a bargain.
With so much effort going into
producing the water in your tap, you
should appreciate a glass of water
SC
even more.
The salty discharge water on its way back to the ocean. The salt level is double
normal levels but it quickly disperses in the ocean. In the background you can
see the sand filters that are used to clean the incoming sea water by removing
large particles such as sediment and algae. (courtesy Water Corporation)
shoot the outflow upwards from the
sea bed to encourage mixing. Before
construction this design was tested
by the University of NSW in a large
swimming pool.
Overall, the designers aim to mix the
outflow to such an extent that the salinity of the water reaches normal levels
at 50 to 75 metres from the outlets.
Drinkable water
The water produced by reverse
osmosis technology is essentially
pure but still needs processing. So a
desalination plant must include a post
18 Silicon Chip
treatment stage which adds components such as fluoride that we expect
in out drinking water.
This stage also adds alkalinity to
the soft processed water. A similar
treatment stage is used for soft dam
waters as this prevents corrosion in the
distribution system. In keeping with
other treatment methods, chlorine is
also added for cleansing and maintenance of the distribution system.
Finally the water is fed into the
municipal water reticulation system.
Because the plant is run continuously
the engineers will throttle back other
Monitoring buoys are used to monitor
salt concentration, dissolved oxygen
and many other parameters. If these
exceed safe levels the desalination
plant will be shut down until the
ocean currents can return the sea
water to acceptable levels.
(courtesy Water Corporation)
siliconchip.com.au
1 2 3 4 5 6. . .
NOW AVAILABLE:
SIX MONTH
SUBSCRIPTIONS
& AUTO RENEWALS
In these tough economic times, we understand that taking out a one or two-year subscription may be
difficult. Or perhaps you’d like a trial before committing yourself to a full sub.
Either way, we’ve made it easy with our new six-month subscriptions. It’s the easy way to make sure you
don’t miss an issue . . . and a six month subscription is STILL CHEAPER than the over-the-counter price
AND we pick up the postage tab. Have SILICON CHIP delivered to your door every month, normally a few
days BEFORE it goes on sale in newsagents (grab some of the advertised bargains early!).
We also offer the convenience of auto-renewal if you wish: we’ll renew your subscription for the same
period automatically when the time comes. It’s simple and easy – you don’t have to do a thing!
Don’t forget: subscribers automatically qualify for 10% discount on other SILICON CHIP merchandise.
IF ELECTRONICS IS YOUR BUSINESS OR TRADE, A SILICON CHIP SUBSCRIPTION IS NORMALLY 100% TAX DEDUCTIBLE!
To
Place
Your
Order:
eMAIL (24/7)
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
with order & credit card details
OR
FAX (24/7)
This form (or a photocopy) to
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
OR
PAYPAL (24/7)
OR
Use PayPal to pay
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
MAIL
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
your credit card details
This form to PO Box 139
Collaroy NSW 2097
OR
SUBSCRIPTION LENGTH AND TYPE:
q AUSTRALIA 6 MONTHS (INC. GST) (NEW!).............................. $49.50
(PLEASE PRINT)
q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS (INC. GST)......................................... $94.50
Address______________________________________________________________ q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS WITH BINDER (INC. GST) .............. $111.00
q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS (INC. GST)....................................... $182.00
q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS WITH BINDER (INC. GST) .............. $215.00
____________________________________________Postcode_________________
q NEW ZEALAND 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)....................$AU55.00
q NEW ZEALAND 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)...............................$AU99.00
Phone ( )_____________ Email address __________________________________ q NEW ZEALAND 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) ...........................$AU196.00
(Daytime number, please)
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!).....$AU75.00
Method of Payment: q EFT (ring or email for details) q Cheque/Money Order q PayPal q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)..............$AU135.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) ............$AU260.00
q Visa
NEW! CONVENIENT AUTOMATIC
q MasterCard
SUBSCRIPTION RENEWAL:
Your Name____________________________________________________________
q Tick here if you’d like us to automatically renew your subscription
Card Expiry:
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
Signature______________________________
THIS PAGE MAY BE PHOTOCOPIED WITHOUT INFRINGING COPYRIGHT
as it elapses (ie, 6 month, 12 month or 24 month).
We’ll renew until you tell us to stop!
July 2009 19
July 2009 19
Two
cost
reco
He’s held onto a large library of VHS tapes for decades so Barrie
Smith thought he could make good use of the Easter break by
engaging with DVD recording. Here are his reactions to a Tevion
DD1018 and an AWA DR711 DVD recorder.
I
t was very much due to our Prime
Minister’s urging to ‘spend, spend,
spend’ that I fell upon the ALDI
catalog with gusto: a DVD recorder
for $99!
Zipping down to the local ALDI
on Easter Saturday, I laid down the
plastic and helped the economies of
three countries in one swoop: China
as the makers, Germany (who own the
retailer ALDI) and hopefully, a band of
Australian staffers working for the latter.
Before getting on to the main topic,
I’ve noticed that something funny has
been going on in the retailing of disc
recorders: there are heaps of DVD
recorders with 80/160/250 Gigabyte
hard drives as their primary storage
and selling for $400-500, with a solitary model at $299.
Parallel to this you can get your
hands on a couple of Blu-Ray recorders
from Panasonic, with prices starting
at around $1600. So I felt the arrival
of the low-cost Tevion DD1018 was a
significant event.
Looks and Feel
The unit is a neat package in black
with external controls placed on the
upper edge. A drop-down front panel
gives access to composite audio and
video inputs, along with a camcorder
DV input.
20 Silicon Chip
Round the back we face a whole
complex of in/outputs: RF in/output
loop; composite audio/video in/outputs along with an S-Video output;
component Y, Cb/Pb, Cr/Pr inputs are
there as well as a pile of audio ports
for Dolby 5.1 channel outputs.
The remote control does a sterling
job by expanding the options via 50
buttons (of which ten are channel
numbers) with choices of front or
rear composite inputs plus RF, audio
volume up/down buttons, all the usual
DVD navigation tools, channel selection via the internal analog tuner as
well as a timer to record time shifted
programs … the Tevion can also ‘one
touch’ record at any time.
The on-screen menus are well set
out and copious in variety. However,
due to the nature of DVD and its multiple skills and requirements, you do
need a fair amount of study to get it
going.
This is how I and my teenage son
spent Easter Sunday; logging the
channels into the menu, assigning
program positions and making many
test recordings. Little did I know at this
stage that this exercise would need to
be repeated twice more.
Single Layer
The Tevion replays DVDs containing NTSC/PAL programming and
CD-R/RWs with AIFF and MP3 tracks.
Discs with JPEG images are OK as well
as Picture CD material, Video CDs, Super VCDs, HDCD and MPEG4. It will
also record SD video to Single Layer
DVD+/-RW and DVD+/-R media.
It will not record to Dual Layer DVDs
… but that’s OK I guess, because the
recording options are wide.
The recording quality choices are
shown in the table below, with the
highest quality (and shortest time) at
the top.
QUALITY
LEVEL
RECORD TIME MBPS RESOLUTION
(hours) (MPEG2)
HQ
High Quality
1
9.716
D1
SP
Standard Play
2
5.037
˝
LP
Long Play
3
3.382
LP
EP
Extended Play
4
2.537
˝
SLP
Super Long Play
6
1.691
SLP
ENCODING
CBR
CBR + VBR
˝
˝
˝
siliconchip.com.au
o lowDVD
orders
Review by
BARRIE SMITH
Early on, I had difficulty in reading
the washed-out on screen menu but
did eventually work my way through
the options.
The timer menu was an easy one
and compared to VHS machines, offered far more elegant ways to time
shift than Ye Olde tape machine. After
you choose channel number, date and
time of recording commencement you
then have only to select the length of
recording in hours and minutes taking
care to choose the recording quality
that will comfortably encompass the
record time.
Of course, the Muggins way is to
select SLP, which gives six hours of
recording but at the lowest quality.
Thinking users will naturally juggle
record time and quality level in their
decision-making.
Post recording, you must finalise
the DVD, with both DVD-R and DVDRW discs. Doing so enables the disc
to be played on any other compatible
machine, just like a commercial DVD.
But doing this changes the disc format
so that you can no longer record to it,
turning it into a ‘play only’ disc; this
makes a DVD-R no longer writeable.
By using a DVD-RW platter you can
still finalise the disc for replaying in
another player, then return it to the
Tevion, ‘unfinalise’ it, remove the exsiliconchip.com.au
isting programming and accumulate
extra recordings, much in the way of
Ye Olde VHS but with the attractive
advantage of replay access in a random
fashion, via on screen icons indicating
the programs on offer. It’s a great way
to travel!
I didn’t get into DVD+R/RW discs;
for one thing they are far more expen-
sive than DVD-R/RWs and don’t seem
to offer any advantages.
Back to recording: after you’ve
committed pictures and sound to a
disc, and before finalising, there is
an option to rename the text that accompanies the program icon: you get
only 11 characters but I found this is
more than enough for an ID. There is
The Tevion DVD
recorder is styled
in black with
external controls
on the upper edge.
A drop-down
door reveals the
standard yellow
(video) and red/
white (stereo
audio) inputs
along with its
DV input. The
Tevion’s rear
hookup panel has
a host of inputs
and outputs,
including a
duplication of
the video and
audio inputs from
the front panel.
As you can see,
it also features
antenna in and
out, S-video and
more.
July 2009 21
Tevion’s on screen display of a JPEG still image. Ignore
the digital camera interference lines – this is seriously
under-saturated. And this was the better of the two
Tevions I tried – I’d taken the first one back already!
also an option to select a frame of the
program as a visual ID.
Another nicety is that the Tevion
can insert chapter markers into the
program; these will be automatically
spaced five, ten and fifteen minutes
apart during the recording.
By now you’re probably thinking
this piece of hardware is a whizzer;
well, not quite.
The first warning should have
sounded when I found the on-screen
menu a bit washed out but the penny
didn’t drop until I made a recording,
and then replayed it.
Show me the colour!
Where’s all the colour, I cried out?
It didn’t matter whether I tweaked the
Tevion’s colour saturation/contrast/
brightness, adjusted the TV, darkened
the room, pulled the curtains – the
colour depth was just not there.
Taking the disc to other DVD players (I’ve got three – don’t ask why!)
revealed full-bodied colour.
A phone call to Tevion tech support
elicited the advice to swap the unit at
ALDI for another. Which I did. Took it
home, re-installed it. This was better;
at least now I could read the menus
more easily. But the replay was still
noticeably desaturated.
At this point I decided to run a
colour chart past the Tevion, showing
the primaries: red, green, blue as well
as the complementary hues: cyan,
magenta and yellow.
It was apparent that the primaries
were fine on the Tevion but the system
was not delivering magenta (mix of
22 Silicon Chip
Compare this off-screen shot of the same Manly ferry
image, as displayed by the AWA DR711 recorder. Note
how much more saturated the image is and as a result,
how much more detail there is. Oh bliss, oh joy!
blue and red) or yellow (mix of red
and green), whereas the other players were delivering all primaries and
complementaries. Not happy, Jan!
AWA to the rescue
By this time matters had become
a little more complex as Big W announced the sale of their entry, a
nicely satin-chromed model AWA
DR711, with cosmetic differences but
with a near-identical feature list and
specs. Same factory in China? Possibly. Price? $148.
Being a canny shopper I managed
to snaffle one just two days before the
price dropped to an on-sale special of
$128! But the good news was that at
last I could see the on-screen menu
clearly and matters only got better as
I viewed on-air broadcasts and then
ran some tests.
What a difference! Colours were
now fully on while the brightness and
contrast range were good.
The AWA unit is identical in
features and operating modes to the
Tevion, while the remote control differs slightly. It is obviously the one
to go for. I’m now very happy with
my purchase and plan to retire the
home VCRs for day-to-day recording.
Disc is in.
But you’re probably wondering
why I bought a DVD recorder with an
analog tuner instead of considering a
more expensive unit with an inbuilt
digital tuner.
My attitude is that analog TV
transmissions have some years to run
before they cease to be broadcast and
even after that, I will be able to couple
A/V signals from my set-top box to the
DVD recorder.
In the meantime, I have the use of a
DVD recorder at a bargain price.
The Tevion screen
display of an
RGB/CMY chart.
The primary
colours appear
OK on the Tevion
but the system
does not correctly
deliver magenta
(mix of blue and
red) nor yellow
(mix of red and
green). It wasn’t
an isolated dud:
this is the better of
the two Tevions I
tried before giving
up on them and
going to AWA.
siliconchip.com.au
AWA DR711 Specifications
Power Supply: .................. AC 100V-240V/50Hz-60Hz, 35W.
Signal Modulation: ........... PAL/NTSC.
Radium Laser: .................. Wavelength 650nm, 780nm.
Frequency Response:........ DVD audio: 4Hz-22kHz (48kHz sample frequency).
4Hz-44kHz (96kHz sample frequency).
......................................... CD audio: 4Hz-20kHz.
S/N: .................................. >90dB.
Dynamic Range: ............... >90dB.
Operating temperature: .... 0-40° C.
Video out: ......................... 1.0V (P-P),
S-Video out: ..................... (Y) 1.0V (P-P) 75; (C) 0.286V (P-P), 75
Audio output: ................... 2.0V (RMS maximum).
Receiving Modulation: ..... PAL I, PAL D/K, PAL B/G, SECAM, L SECAM D/K SECAM B/G.
Last Thoughts
As we all know, the majority of
consumer electronic products is
manufactured in China, either under
an international monicker like Sony,
Panasonic etc or a truckload of generic
labels, like Tevion, AWA and many
others. With the major brands you can
presume the companies keep a strict
eye on the products before they reach
the market.
With generic brands, sold through
retail outlets, one can only presume
that a similar degree of surveillance
is applied before the items are placed
on shop shelves before sale.
From my experience with these two
ostensibly identical DVD recorders it
would appear that, in the case of one
retailer, this degree of quality control
was not maintained.
SC
SMART
PROCUREMENT
SOLUTIONS
Unit 3, 61-63 Steel Street
Capalaba QLD 4157
AUSTRALIA
Ph (07) 3390 3302
Fx (07) 3390 3329
sales<at>rmsparts.com.au
www.rmsparts.com.au
o Resistors
o Capacitors
o Potentiometers
o Crystals
o Semiconductors
o Optoelectronics
o Relays
o Buzzers
o Connectors
o Switches
o Hardware
o Chemicals & Fluxes
While cosmetically different to the Tevion, the AWA has similar specs and
operating modes. The rear panel also reveals S- Video input as well as output
along with optical audio (Toslink) and coaxial output. Apart from more
versatile, it significantly out-performs the Tevion in the colour department.
siliconchip.com.au
WHOLESALERS
DISTRIBUTORS
KITTING SOLUTIONS
July 2009 23
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
dicksmith.com.au
Mk.3 Lead-Acid Battery
Zapper and
Desulphator
Here is a revised version of the popular Lead-Acid
Battery Zapper featured in the May 2006 issue of
SILICON CHIP. It is now separate from the Battery
Condition Checker and much easier to build. At the
same time it has been revamped for more reliable
long-period operation with 6V, 12V & 24V batteries.
By JIM ROWE
T
HE LEAD-ACID Battery Zapper
& Condition Checker published
in the May 2006 issue has been a
very popular project but since it was
published a few shortcomings have
become apparent. The metering circuit on the Battery Condition Checker
sometimes had a tendency to “lock up”
on the 6V range and the current pulse
Disclaimer!
Not all batteries can be rejuvenated by zapping. They may be too
heavily sulphated or may have an
open-circuit cell connection. Nor
can the zapper restore a battery
which is worn out; ie, one in which
the active material on the plates has
been severely degraded.
Depending on the battery, it is also
possible that any rejuvenation effect
may only be temporary.
26 Silicon Chip
loading circuit was sometimes un
stable with 24V batteries, if the power
switching MOSFETs were at the high
end of their transconductance range.
In addition, the test current pulse
amplitude was fixed at about 30A; OK
for car batteries but too high for batteries used in motorbikes and for sealed
lead acid (SLA) batteries.
Many readers also found the combination of the Battery Zapper & Condition Checker fairly tricky to assemble
and disassemble because it was a bit
of a shoe-horn job into the plastic case.
In view of this, we recently decided
to develop improved versions of both
the Checker and the Zapper but to
feature them as separate projects, to
make them easier to build and use. The
revised Battery Condition Checker is
planned for publication next month.
What the Zapper does
First of all, let’s have a quick recap
about zapping and what it’s all about.
Lead-acid batteries have been used
to store electrical energy for over 170
years – ever since Gaston Plante built
the first one back in 1834. But lead-acid
batteries are not without their faults.
Probably their main drawback is that
they tend to have a relatively short
working life, typically no more than
about three years although with care,
they can last much longer than that.
So why such a short life? Well, every
time energy is drawn from a leadacid battery, lead and sulphate ions
from the electrolyte combine and are
deposited on the plates in the form of
soft lead-sulphate crystals. Then when
the battery is recharged, these crystals
dissolve again in the sulphuric acid
electrolyte.
At least MOST of them redissolve –
but not all. Even if the battery is never
over-discharged and always recharged
promptly after it has been discharged,
a small proportion of the lead sulphate
crystals tend to remain on the plates,
siliconchip.com.au
where they harden into crystals of a
much less soluble and less conductive
“hard” lead sulphate.
The formation of these hard lead
sulphate crystals gradually reduces the
energy storage capacity of the battery,
both by masking the active areas on
the plates and also by reducing the
concentration of lead and sulphate
ions in the electrolyte.
This “sulphation” effect has been
known about for many years. It’s
also well known that the effect happens much faster if a battery is overdischarged, left in a discharged state
for long periods, or frequently undercharged. Batteries mistreated in these
ways tend to have a particularly short
working life.
For a long time, sulphation was
regarded as non-reversible and batteries that had lost too much of their
capacity from it were simply junked.
This was not only wasteful but caused
an environmental problem, because
siliconchip.com.au
LITTLE GEM DIGITAL MULTIMETER
37.25 v
WOW
WOW
WOW
WOW
ZAPPER
WOW
V
+
+
–
–
METER
ZAPPING
20A
DIGITAL
MULTIMETER
WOW
WOW
SILICON
CHIP
A
WOW
WOW
WOW
WOW
2A
COM
+V
– +
LEAD-ACID BATTERY
ZAPPER/DESULPHATOR
+
+
FUSE 3A
BATTERY
FU
SE
–
24V
BATTERY
CHARGER
6V/12V
ON
ON
+
–
+
BATTERY CHARGER
CHARGER
–
–
MIGHTY QUICK
BATTERY CHARGER
0
1
2
3
4
+
–
5
BATTERY
+
–
Fig.1: here’s how the Battery Zapper is connected to a battery and charger.
The multimeter monitors the zapping pulses and should be set to a range
of 100V DC or more. In addition, make sure that the Battery Voltage switch
(S1) is set in the correct position for the battery you’re going to be zapping.
July 2009 27
Parts List
1 ABS Jiffy box, UB2 size (197 x
113 x 83mm)
1 PC board, code 04107091, 185
x 100mm
3 SPDT mini toggle switches (S1S3)
2 speaker box binding posts, red
(Jaycar PP-0434 or equivalent)
2 speaker box binding posts, black
(Jaycar PP-0435 or equivalent)
1 Premium binding post, red (Jaycar PT-0460 or equivalent)
1 Premium binding post, black
(Jaycar PT-0461)
1 M205 LV panel-mounting fuseholder
1 3A slow blow M205 fuse cartridge (F1)
2 6073B type TO-200 heatsinks
(HS1, HS2)
1 8-pin DIL IC socket
1 220µH air-cored inductor (L1)
both lead and sulphuric acid are highly
toxic materials.
Around the middle of last century
though, farmers in rural areas discovered that they seemed to be able to
resuscitate sulphated batteries and
extend their life by zapping them with
the high-voltage pulses from their
electric fence controllers. They didn’t
quite know how this method worked
but kept using it simply because it did.
Then in 1976, the US Patent Office
granted a patent to William H. Clark
of Salt Lake City, Utah, for a method
2 1mH air-cored inductors (L2, L3)
3 Nylon cable ties, 250-300mm
4 M3 x 25mm tapped spacers
6 M3 x 6mm machine screws, pan
head
4 M3 x 6mm machine screws,
countersunk head
8 M3 flat washers
2 M3 hex nuts
1 400mm length 1mm tinned copper wire
1 300mm length 0.7mm tinned
copper wire
Semiconductors
1 555 timer (IC1)
1 BC327 PNP transistor (Q1)
1 IRF540N MOSFET (Q2)
2 6.8V 1W zener diodes (ZD1,ZD2)
1 30V 1W zener diode (ZD3)
1 27V 1W zener diode (ZD4)
1 5mm red LED (LED1)
of charging lead-acid batteries by
means of narrow high current pulses
– claimed to dissolve the lead sulphate
crystals and hence prolong battery
life. Since then, a number of designs
for pulse-type battery rejuvenators or
“zappers” have appeared in electronics magazines around the world.
We should point out that there
is still argument and controversy
about whether or not the sulphation
of flooded lead-acid batteries can be
reversed. That in turn means there is
still argument about the effectiveness
+12V
+
K
L2
1mH
–
A
SWITCH
(Q2)
28 Silicon Chip
+
–
470 F
Fig.2(a): during the first phase of
the circuit’s operation, current
flows from the battery (and/or
battery charger) and charges a
470mF electrolytic capacitor via
1mH inductor L2.
of zapper-type pulse rejuvenators.
However, many people have reported
achieving a useful amount of rejuvenation on badly sulphated batteries,
using zappers – including our earlier
designs. That’s why we’re describing
this new version.
At the same time, we should also
point out that this zapping process
does not appear to work with sealed
lead acid (SLA) batteries with a “gel”
electrolyte. So we don’t recommend
building the Battery Zapper to try
rejuvenating this type of battery.
L2
1mH
K
L1
220 H
A CAPACITOR CHARGING PHASE
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 1MΩ
1 470Ω 5W wirewound
1 270kΩ
1 150Ω
1 27kΩ
1 100Ω
1 15kΩ
1 15Ω 5W wirewound
1 6.8kΩ
I pulse
(D3)
A
Capacitors
1 470µF 63V low ESR RB electrolytic
1 470µF 16V low ESR RB electrolytic
1 470nF 100V MKT polyester
1 100nF 100V MKT polyester
1 22nF 100V MKT polyester
3 10nF 100V MKT polyester
1 4.7nF 100V MKT polyester
+12V
FROM BATTERY
AND/OR
CHARGER
I charge
(D3)
2 1N4148 diodes (D1,D2)
1 BY229-200 fast recovery diode
(D3)
2 UF4003 ultra-fast diodes (D4,D5)
SWITCH
(Q2)
B
L2
1mH
K
12V
(D3)
L1
220 H
I transfer
A
–
+
470 F
ENERGY TRANSFER PHASE
Fig.2(b): next, switch Q2 is closed
for 50ms, and current flows from
the capacitor into L1. As a result,
the energy stored in the capacitor
is transferred to the inductor’s
magnetic field.
L1
220 H
470 F
SWITCH
(Q2)
C DISCHARGE/PULSE GENERATION PHASE
Fig.2(c): finally, switch Q2 opens
again, interrupting the inductor
current and causing a high-voltage
pulse across the inductor with the
polarity shown. The green arrow
shows the discharge current path.
siliconchip.com.au
24V
BATTERY
S1 VOLTS
6/12V
100
K
470 F
16V
LOW
ESR
100nF
27k
K
A
A
BATTERY
470 5W
A
ZD1
6.8V
1W
LED1
ZD2
6.8V
1W
K
L2
1mH
AIR
K
D3
BY229-200
A
7
6
D1
K
8
4
6.8k
3
IC1
555
A
A
Q2
IRF540N
4.7nF
E
B
C
K
D
G
A
S
Q1
BC327
CHARGE ON/OFF
S3
CHARGER +
10nF 100V
D5
UF4003
A
150
15 5W
D4
UF4003
K
1
10nF
L3
1mH
AIR
L1
220 H
AIR
5
2
22nF
100V
K
D2
BATTERY +
10nF 100V
A
270k
S2
F1 3A
K
15k
A
ZD3
30V
1W
ZD4
27V
1W
METER +
K
470 F
63V
LOW
ESR
470nF
100V
1M
METER –
CHARGER –
BATTERY –
D1, D2: 1N4148
A
K
D4,D5: UF4003
A
SC
2009
K
ZD1–ZD4
A
K
K
A
BY229-200
BC327
LED
IRF540N
K
D
B
E
C
K
LEAD-ACID BATTERY ZAPPER MK3
G
A
D
S
Fig.3: the circuit uses 555 timer IC1 to turn MOSFET Q2 on for 50µs every 1ms (ie, at a 1kHz rate). Transistor Q1
turns on and shorts Q2’s gate to ground each time IC1’s pin 3 output switches low to ensure a fast turn off, while zener
diodes ZD3 and ZD4 form an over-voltage protection circuit for Q2, which has a maximum voltage rating of 100V.
It’s also worth noting that even
on flooded lead-acid batteries, pulse
desulphation is not quick. It can involve tens or even hundreds of hours
to achieve a significant amount of
rejuvenation.
How it works
As with our earlier units, the new
Battery Zapper converts some of the
energy from the battery itself (usually
aided by a battery charger) into narrow high-voltage pulses which are fed
back to the battery. This is done using
the basic circuit configuration shown
in Fig.2, which also shows its three
operating phases.
In the first phase (A), current flows
from the battery and/or charger
through 1mH inductor L2 and charges
a 470µF capacitor connected between
the inductor’s lower end and earth
(battery negative). This phase lasts
for about 950µs – long enough for the
capacitor to charge up to the battery
voltage.
siliconchip.com.au
At the end of this charging phase,
switch Q2 (a power MOSFET) is closed
for about 50µs (B), shorting the lower
end of 220µH inductor L1 to ground
and effectively connecting it right
across the charged 470µF capacitor.
As a result most of the energy stored
in the capacitor is transferred into the
inductor’s magnetic field. Hence this
second phase is known as the energy
transfer phase.
The third phase (C) begins when
switch Q2 is opened again. This breaks
the inductor’s transfer current, which
causes a high voltage back-EMF pulse
to be generated across L1 with the polarity shown. Fast recovery diode D3
then feeds this high voltage pulse back
to the battery, as shown in Fig.1(c).
The third phase is therefore known
as the discharge/pulse generation
phase.
Circuit details
Refer now to Fig.3 for the full circuit
details of our new Lead Acid Battery
Zapper. You should now be able to
identify this basic pulse generation circuit in the centre of the diagram. The
discharging switch Q2 is now shown
in its true form as an IRF540N power
MOSFET, which we’re using here as a
fast electronic switch. Virtually all of
the circuitry to the left of Q2 is used to
switch it on and off repeatedly, so that
the pulse generating circuit produces
a stream of zapping pulses.
The pulses used to switch Q2 on and
off are generated by IC1, a 555 timer.
This is configured as an astable oscillator running at about 1kHz but with an
output consisting of narrow positive
pulses about 50µs wide, with spaces
of about 950µs between them (ie, a
1:19 mark-space ratio). Each of these
narrow pulses is used to turn on Q2,
with diode D2 and transistor Q1 used
to ensure that Q2 is switched both on
and off as rapidly as possible.
So Q2 is turned on for 50µs, then off
for 950µs and so on. The 150Ω resistor
in series with Q2’s gate is included to
July 2009 29
UF4003
6.8k
F
S
K
BT229-200
D4
L2 1mH
A
D3
+
ZAPPING
LED1
METER-
CABLE TIE
15k
Q1
BC327
63V
22nF
+B
9002 ©
FU
SE
3A
CHARGER
BATTERY
S2
S1
10nF
BAT VOLTS
10nF
470 5W
DI CA-DAEL
YRETTA B
3K M REPPA Z
19070141
BATTERY-
F1
BATTERY+
CABLE TIE
470 F
S3
+C
L3 1mH
15 5W
S
CHARGER+
100
METER+
1M
150
D2
4148
F
S
470nF
10nF
4.7nF
27k
4148
270k
ZD1
ZD2
D5
+M
L1 220 H
D1
470 F
27V
UF4003
IC1
555
6V8
ZD4
30V
Q2
IRF540N
100nF
6V8
ZD3
CHARGER-
CABLE TIE
F
Fig.4: follow this parts layout diagram to assemble the PC board
and make sure that all polarised parts are orientated as shown. The
large inductors (L1-L3) are secured to the board using plastic cable
ties which pass through holes on either side.
suppress any tendency for it to oscillate during the switching transitions.
That’s all there is in the basic zapping circuit. Now let’s look at the
refinements.
Zener diodes ZD1 and ZD2 are included to prevent the supply voltage
for IC1 from rising above 13.6V, espe30 Silicon Chip
cially when the Battery Zapper is being
used with a 24V battery. They do not
conduct any significant current when
6V batteries are being zapped and for
12V batteries they only serve as a limiter for any zapping pulses which find
their way back from the cathode of D3,
via the 100Ω series resistor.
Note that switch S1 inserts a 470Ω
5W resistor in series with the 100Ω
resistor when the unit is being used
with a 24V battery, to limit the dissipation in ZD1 and ZD2.
Zener diodes ZD3 and ZD4 form an
over-voltage protection circuit for Q2,
which has a maximum voltage rating
of 100V. These zener diodes limit the
maximum pulse voltage to about 70V
under all conditions.
Pulse level monitoring
D5 is an ultra-fast diode which
forms part of a simple half-wave rectifier circuit with the 1MΩ resistor and
470nF reservoir capacitor. These provide a DC voltage proportional to the
maximum pulse amplitude between
the “Meter” terminals, to allow monitoring the pulse level with a standard
(high-impedance) digital multimeter.
LED1 indicates when the Battery
Zapper is generating pulses and also
gives a rough idea of their amplitude.
Because the pulses are quite narrow,
diode D4 is used to charge the 22nF
capacitor to their full voltage (less
the battery voltage across the 470µF
capacitor) and the LED is able to draw
a steady current from the capacitor via
the 6.8kΩ resistor. This allows LED1
to glow fairly brightly, without taking
too much of the energy in the zapping
pulses.
Fuse F1 is provided mainly to protect inductors L2 and L1 against damage in the event of Q2 developing a
short circuit or being switched on continuously due to a fault in IC1 and its
associated components. The circuitry
at upper right is to allow safe connection and disconnection of the unit to
a battery (via switch S2) and also to
allow safe connection or disconnection of a standard battery charger to
the battery at any time, via switch S3.
Inductor L3 acts as a choke for the
zapping pulses, preventing the charger
from absorbing them and possibly being damaged, while the 10nF capacitors across both S2 and S3 are spark
suppressors. The 15Ω 5W resistor
between L3 and S3 is there to limit
the current that can be drawn from the
charger, preventing damage should the
battery develop a short circuit during
zapping.
Construction
To make the new Battery Zapper as
easy as possible to build, virtually all
the components are mounted on a PC
siliconchip.com.au
This view shows the fully assembled
PC board. Note that the three toggle
switches would not normally be
mounted on the board at this stage but
are instead fitted with extension leads
and mounted on the lid of the case –
see text.
Warning!
(1) This circuit generates highvoltage pulses which could easily
damage the electronics in a vehicle.
Do not connect it to a car battery
installed in a vehicle.
(2) Hydrogen gas (which is explosive) is generated by lead-acid
batteries during charging. For this
reason, be sure to always charge
batteries in a well-ventilated area.
board coded 14107091 and measuring 185 x 100mm. This PC board has
rounded cut-outs in each corner so it
will fit snugly inside a standard UB2size ABS utility (Jiffy) box.
The only components which don’t
mount directly on the PC board are
switches S1-S3, the fuseholder for fuse
F1 and the various input terminals.
All of these off-board components
mount on the box lid (which becomes
(3) Never connect high-current
loads directly to a battery’s terminals. This can lead to arcing at the
terminals and could even cause the
battery to explode! Note too that the
electrolyte inside lead-acid batteries is corrosive, so wearing safety
glasses is always a good idea.
the front panel) and are connected to
the board beneath via short lengths
of tinned copper wire, as you can see
from the parts layout diagram of Fig.4
and the cross-section diagram of Fig.6.
Begin assembly of the PC board by
fitting the wire links. There are only
two of these and they’re both only
10mm long (horizontal section), so
they are easily made from resistor
lead off-cuts. After the links, fit the
(4) This unit is not suitable for use
with SLA batteries.
Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
siliconchip.com.au
No.
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Value
1MΩ
270kΩ
27kΩ
15kΩ
6.8kΩ
470Ω 5W
150Ω
100Ω
15Ω 5W
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black green brown
red violet yellow brown
red violet orange brown
brown green orange brown
blue grey red brown
not applicable
brown green brown brown
brown black brown brown
not applicable
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black yellow brown
red violet black orange brown
red violet black red brown
brown green black red brown
blue grey black brown brown
not applicable
brown green black black brown
brown black black black brown
not applicable
July 2009 31
36
A
36
A
C
41
19
C
B
45
5
37
56
D
19
E
D
23
F
F
F
40.5
20
20
D
57
28
D
10
A
10
36
A
36
HOLES A: 3.5mm DIAMETER, CSK
HOLE B:
5.0mm DIAMETER
HOLES C: 10.0mm DIAMETER
CL
HOLES D: 6.0mm DIAMETER
HOLE E: 13.0mm DIAMETER
HOLES F: 6.5mm DIAMETER
ALL DIMENSIONS IN MILLIMETRES
Fig.5: the drilling template for the front panel (ie, the lid of the case). Drill
small pilot holes first & use a tapered reamer to make the larger holes.
8-pin socket for IC1, making sure you
orientate it with the notch end to the
left so it will guide you later when
plugging in IC1.
32 Silicon Chip
Next, fit the smaller resistors, then
fit the two larger 5W resistors which
are in ceramic block packages. It’s a
good idea to fit these about 1mm above
the board rather than flat down on it.
This will provide them with a small
amount of ventilation and also protect
the board from damage if they should
become overheated.
Follow these parts with the capacitors, starting with the smaller nonpolarised MKT parts and then moving
to the electrolytics. There are only two
of the latter but be sure to fit them in
the correct places and with the correct
orientation, otherwise you’ll strike
trouble later.
Now you can fit the semiconductor
parts, starting with diodes D1, D2, D4
& D5 and then zener diodes ZD1-ZD4
and transistor Q1. Once they’re in,
fit diode D3 and power MOSFET Q2.
These are both in TO-220 packages
and are mounted flat on the top of the
PC board along with small 6073B-type
heatsinks. In both cases, their leads
must be bent down by 90° about 6mm
away from the bodies, so they’ll pass
down through the matching holes in
the PC board.
The tabs of both devices are then
secured down against the heatsink
using an M3 x 6mm machine screw
and M3 nut. Then when the screws
are nuts are tightened, the board is
upended and the device leads soldered
to the pads underneath. Don’t solder
the leads before bolting them down,
otherwise you could crack the copper
tracks as the screws are tightened.
Once D3 and Q2 are in place you
can fit LED1. This mounts vertically in
the upper centre of the board, with its
leads straight and with the underside
of its body spaced about 24mm above
the board so that it will later just protrude through its matching hole in the
front panel.
With LED1 in place, now is the time
to fit the largest components which
mount on the board: the three aircored inductors. During this process,
it’s important to dress each inductor’s
leads carefully so they’re straight and
at 90° to the side cheeks of the inductor
bobbin. This will allow the leads to
be fed through their matching board
holes without strain as each inductor
is lowered into position.
Be sure to orientate each inductor so
that its “start” lead (near the centre of
the bobbin) passes through the matching “S” hole on the board, while its
“finish” lead (on the outside) passes
through the hole marked “F”.
When each inductor is sitting flat
down against the top of the board,
siliconchip.com.au
CHARGER
NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
M205
BOX LID/ FUSEHOLDER
FRONT PANEL
CHARGER
POSITIVE
TERMINAL
BATTERY
POSITIVE
TERMINAL
S1,S2,S3
S1
L3
1mH/20AWG
470 5W
15 5W
PC BOARD MOUNTED BEHIND PANEL
VIA FOUR M3 x 25mm TAPPED SPACERS
WITH 2x FLAT WASHERS UNDER EACH ONE
CABLE TIE SECURING
L3 TO PC BOARD
PC BOARD
NOTE: BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL OMITTED FOR CLARITY
Fig.6: this end-elevation diagram shows how the PC board is mounted on the
back of the lid on M3 x 25mm tapped spacers & washers. The front panel
parts are connected to the PC board via “extension” wires.
Left: the charger, battery
& meter terminals are
all mounted on the lid of
the case, along with the
fuse and toggle switches
(not shown here), before
the PC board is attached.
XYBER
Data Recovery
Data recovery for the rest of us: reliable,
affordable, thorough, fast, professional.
MacOS•Windows•Novell•Linux•Servers
Disk•Flash•Optical•MO•RAID•NAS•SAN
Data•Photo•Audio•Video•Forensics
Wholly Australian and proud of it :-)
www.xyber.com.au
Xyber. At your service. Since 1985.
1800 88 31 77
into its socket, taking care to fit it with
the correct orientation. The board assembly can then be placed aside while
you prepare the box lid/front panel.
Drilling the front panel
you can solder its leads to the pads
underneath and trim off any excess.
A 250mm-long Nylon cable tie is then
used to hold the inductor in place. As
shown, this tie passes down through
one of the edge holes provided in
the board and up through the other.
siliconchip.com.au
Tighten the ties quite firmly to secure
each inductor in place.
Finally, cut off the excess ends of
the cable ties, leaving only about 4mm.
Once all three inductors have been
fitted to the board, it is almost complete. All that remains is to plug IC1
Preparing the front panel requires
15 holes to be drilled and reamed.
Their sizes and positions are shown
in Fig.5, which is also shown actual
size so you can use a photocopy as a
drilling template if you wish.
After all of the holes have been
drilled and de-burred, you may want
to fit the lid/panel with a stick-on
escutcheon to give it a more professional finish. To make this step easier,
we have produced an artwork for the
front panel – see Fig.7.
The easiest way to make a front
panel is to photocopy the artwork onto
an adhesive-backed A4 label sheet,
over which is then applied a sheet
of protective clear self-adhesive film
(like “Contact” or “Duraseal”). Then
the artwork can be cut to size and its
backing sheet peeled off, allowing it
to be placed carefully on the top of
the box lid.
Another option is to download the
July 2009 33
artwork from the SILICON CHIP website
and print it out.
Once the label is in place you can
then cut out the various holes in the
escutcheon using a sharp hobby knife,
guided by the holes already drilled in
the lid.
Fuseholder & switches
The next stage is fitting the fuseholder, toggle switches and binding
posts to the front panel. Don’t use
excessive force to tighten the nut on
the fuseholder, as you might strip
the plastic thread. The three toggle
switches are identical, so they can
go in any of the three positions. After
these fit the red and black plastic
binding posts, which are used for the
“Meter” terminals.
The other two pairs of binding posts
are gold-plated speaker terminals and
they probably seem too good for this
application. However, they have the
advantage that they are readily available and will take heavier cables.
They also have a top section which
can be unscrewed completely to allow
connections via crocodile clips. The
binding posts with the red mounting
34 Silicon Chip
The views above
left & top show how
the assembly goes
together, while at
right is the completed
Battery Zapper. Make
sure that all the
extension wires fitted
to the front-panel
items go through their
corresponding holes
in the PC board.
bushes are used for the two positive
terminals.
Extension wires
Once all of these items have been
fitted to the front panel, it can be
turned over and their connection lugs
or spigots fitted with “extension” wires
made from short lengths of tinned copper wire. This is necessary to extend
the leads down through the matching
holes in the PC board when the latter
is mounted up behind the panel.
The extension wires for S1, S2 and
S3 need only be about 25mm long but
with one end bent into a tiny hook so
that it can be attached firmly to the
switch lug before soldering. The wires
used for the fuseholder extensions
should be about 15mm and 30mm
long respectively, with the longer wire
used for the holder’s side connection.
As before, these wires should both
be attached to the fuseholder lugs by
forming them into a small hook before
soldering.
The extension wires used for the
binding posts should be cut from
siliconchip.com.au
LEAD-ACID BATTERY
ZAPPER and
DESULPHATOR
+
METER
–
longer lengths of 1mm diameter tinned
copper wire – about 60mm long. The
centre of each wire is then wound
tightly once around the notch near
the lower end of each binding post’s
spigot, before soldering. The two ends
are then bent down along the axis of
the post and finally twisted together
to form a stout extension wire to pass
down through the board.
All of these extension wire details
are shown clearly in the diagram of
Fig.6.
When all of these extension wires
have been fitted the next step is to
attach the PC board to the panel. This
is done by first mounting an M3 x
25mm tapped spacer to the rear of
the panel near each corner, with M3 x
6mm countersink head screws passing
down through matching holes ‘A’ in
Fig.5. Tighten these screws firmly to
ensure that they don’t work loose later.
Now offer up the PC board assembly
underneath the panel, making sure
both that the various extension wires
pass through their matching holes in
the board and that LED1 also passes up
through its matching hole in the panel.
Then once the board has moved up to
almost touch the spacers (it won’t quite
reach them because of the cable ties
around the inductors), up-end everything to allow you to fit two M3 flat
washers between the board and each
spacer. Secure the assembly using M3
x 6mm machine screws (pan head).
Finally, solder the ends of all of the
extension wires to the copper pads on
the board and clip off any excess wire.
It might all sound complicated but
it’s easier to do than to describe in
words. Fig.6 shows the details.
Your new Battery Zapper should
now be fully wired up and you should
be able to lower the complete front
panel/PC board assembly down onto
the box. The assembly can then be fassiliconchip.com.au
ZAPPING
+
FUSE 3A
BATTERY
–
24V
BATTERY
CHARGER
6V/12V
ON
ON
+
CHARGER
SILICON
CHIP .com.au
–
Fig.7: this full-size front-panel artwork can be photocopied and used direct or
you can download a PDF of the artwork from the SILICON CHIP website and
print it out on a colour printer – see text.
tened to the box using the self-tapping
screws provided. Don’t forget to fit the
small plastic bungs over each screw
recess, to finish the job.
Putting it to use
It’s very easy to connect the Battery Zapper Mk.3 to a battery, charger
and optional DMM – just follow the
connection diagram of Fig.1. Before
you start, make sure that the Battery
Voltage switch (S1) is set in the correct
position for the battery you’re going to
be zapping. Switches S2 and S3 should
both be in their upper “Off” positions.
The other main thing to watch is that
July 2009 35
Fig.8: this scope shot shows the unit working with a 12V battery. The yellow
trace is the voltage waveform seen at the drain of MOSFET Q2, while the green
trace shows the resulting spike waveform impressed across the battery itself.
The blue trace shows the resulting ripple voltage across the 470µF capacitor.
Fig.9: this scope shot shows the Battery Zapper working with a 24V battery. The
yellow trace at top is the voltage waveform seen at the drain of MOSFET Q2 and
is shown at 70V peak-peak. The spike waveform impressed across the battery
(green trace) is 56V peak-to-peak, indicating a battery in need of zapping.
the unit’s battery and charger terminals
are connected to the battery and the
charger respectively with the correct
polarity, ie, positive-to-positive and
36 Silicon Chip
negative-to-negative. If you connect
the battery with incorrect polarity,
you will blow the 3A fuse and the
chances are that you will blow the
MOSFET (Q2) as well. There, you have
been warned!
If you are using a DMM to monitor
the zapping pulses, it is connected to
the Battery Zapper’s meter jacks as
shown. The DMM should be set for a
DC voltage range of 0-100V or more.
To begin zapping a battery which
has a reasonable charge, all you do is
switch S2 to its lower ON position.
Zapping LED1 should begin to glow,
showing that the high-voltage zapping pulses are being generated and
applied to the battery. If you have a
DMM connected, it should be giving
a reading of more than the battery’s
nominal voltage – up to about 70V DC,
depending on the amount of sulphating in the battery.
If you are in a quiet location, you
may also hear a faint 1kHz whistle
from the inductors – further evidence
that the circuit is working.
If Zapping LED1 doesn’t light and
the DMM simply reads the battery’s
nominal voltage (or less), this means
that the battery doesn’t have enough
charge at present even to operate the
Zapper. In that case, apply power to
the charger and turn on the Zapper’s
charger switch S3, to allow the charger
to provide enough current to support
the zapping process. Zapping should
then begin, unless the battery is beyond redemption.
As the zapping progresses, LED1
will tend to glow less brightly, as the
lead sulphate crystals in the battery
are gradually dissolved and the amplitude of the zapping pulses slowly
drops. But be aware that this may take
a considerable time. At the same time
the reading on the DMM should slowly
drop as well, eventually returning to
the battery’s normal “under charge”
terminal voltage.
By the way if you do need to use a
battery charger to allow the zapping
process to proceed, the 15Ω resistor
inside the Battery Zapper will limit
the charging current to less than 1A,
mainly to prevent the battery from
being damaged by over-charging if
zapping needs to continue over several
days. This means that after the zapping
process has been completed, the battery may still need further charging.
Note that, depending on the charge
in the battery, the Battery Zapper
circuit will draw up to 300mA. This
means that you must connect a battery
charger, otherwise the battery will end
SC
up fully discharged.
siliconchip.com.au
SILICON
SILIC
CHIP
siliconchip.com.au
YOUR DETAILS
NEW!
6 MONTH SUBS
AND
AUTO RENEWAL
NOW
AVAILABLE
Order Form/Tax Invoice
Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd
ABN 49 003 205 490
PO BOX 139, COLLAROY NSW 2097
email: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Phone (02) 9939 3295 Fax (02) 9939 2648
This form may be photocopied without infringing copyright.
Your Name_________________________________________________________
(PLEASE PRINT)
Address____________________________________________________________________________________________________
Postcode__________
Daytime Phone No. (
)____________________ Email address ________________________________
Method of Payment: q EFT (ring or email for details) q Cheque/Money Order q PayPal
q Visa Card
q Master Card
Card No. Card expiry date:
Signature_________________________________________________
YOUR ORDER (SILICON CHIP SUBSCRIBERS QUALIFY FOR 10% DISCOUNT (except subscriptions!)
SIMPLY TICK THE ITEMS REQUIRED – DON'T FORGET TO FILL IN DETAILS ABOVE. WE'LL WORK THE TOTAL OUT FOR YOU AND SEND YOU A RECEIPT WITH YOUR ORDER
SILICON CHIP SUBSCRIPTIONS (all prices include P&P)
SILICON CHIP BOOKSHOP (P&P additional – See below)
q AUSTRALIA 6 MONTHS (INC. GST) (NEW!).......................................................$49.50
q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS (INC. GST)..................................................................$94.50
q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS WITH BINDER (INC. GST) .......................................$111.00
q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS (INC. GST)................................................................$182.00
q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS WITH BINDER (INC. GST) .......................................$215.00
q NEW ZEALAND 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)............................................ $AU55.00
q NEW ZEALAND 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)....................................................... $AU99.00
q NEW ZEALAND 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) ................................................... $AU196.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)............................. $AU75.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)...................................... $AU135.00
q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) .................................... $AU260.00
NEW! CONVENIENT AUTOMATIC SUBSCRIPTION RENEWAL:
q Tick here if you'd like us to automatically renew your subscription when it elapses
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
p
q
q
q
q
p
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
(ie, 6 month, 12 month or 24 month). We'll renew until you tell us to stop!
BACK ISSUES/ARTICLE PHOTOCOPIES
q
SILICON CHIP BACK ISSUES*; SC/EA/ETI PHOTOCOPIES
– includes P&P – $12.00 within Australia; $15.00 overseas
*where in stock - photocopy of article supplied where issue is out of stock. EA/ETI: no back
issues left, only photocopies available. Price is for each back issue or each article photocopy.
Nominate issue and article required: Month:...................................... Year:.........................
Article required:.............................................................................................
Please attach list if more than one back issue or photocopy required.
There is a 10% discount for ten or more back issues and//or photocopies
SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE BINDERS
q
Embossed "SILICON CHIP", securely holds 12 months+ of issues
Available in Australia only.......................................................................................$14.95
(P&P is $10.00 per order; buy five or more in one order for FREE P&P)
P&P RATES:
Subscriptions, back issues and project reprints: P&P included
Binders (available Australia only): $10.00 per order; for 5 or more P&P is free.
Books: Aust. $10 per order; NZ: $AU12 per book; Elsewhere $AU18 per book
To
eMAIL (24/7)
Place
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your
with order & credit card details
siliconchip.com.au
Order:
OR
FAX (24/7)
This form (or a photocopy) to
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
OR
AC MACHINES................................................................................................ $66.00
AMATEUR SCIENTIST CD .............................................................................. $62.00
ANALOG CIRCUIT TECHNIQUES W/DIGITAL INT.................... $88.00 NOW $65.00
ANALOG ELECTRONICS............................................................................... $100.00
AUDIO ELECTRONICS.................................................................................. $101.00
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN ............................................................ $95.00
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES ........................................................................ $95.00
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES.................................................................. $60.00
ELECTRONIC PROJECTS FOR CARS (2003).................................................. $12.95
HANDS-ON ZIGBEE ....................................................................................... $96.50
MICROCONTROLLER PROJECTS IN C FOR 8051................... $81.00 NOW $60.00
NEWNES GUIDE TO TELEVISION AND VIDEO TECHNOLOGY........................ $70.00
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE (NEW 3rd EDITION!)............... $137.00 NOW $120. 00
PERFORMANCE ELECTRONICS FOR CARS.................................................... $19.80
PIC IN PRACTICE........................................................................................... $65.00
PIC MICROCONTROLLERS - KNOW IT ALL................................................... $90.00
PIC MICROCONTROLLER - PERSONAL INTRO COURSE............................... $60.00
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV (7th edition)...................................... $49.00
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK .......................................................................... $90.00
PRACT. VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES/POWER ELECT...................................... $105.00
PROGRAMMING 16-BIT MICROCONTROLLERS IN C.................................... $90.00
RADIO, TV AND HOBBIES ON DVD-ROM ...................................................... $62.00
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN...................................................................................... $75.00
SELF ON AUDIO (2nd edition)........................................................................ $90.00
SOLAR SUCCESS - GETTING IT RIGHT EVERY TIME..................................... $47.50
SOLAR THAT REALLY WORKS ...................................................................... $42.50
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z (inc CD-ROM)..................................... $115.00
TV ACROSS AUSTRALIA ............................................................................... $49.95
USING UBUNTU LINUX.................................................................................. $27.00
VIDEO SCRAMBLING AND DESCRAMBLING............................................... $105.00
PAYPAL (24/7)
OR
Use PayPal to pay
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
*ALL ITEMS SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
your credit card details
OR
MAIL
This form to PO Box 139
Collaroy
NSW 2097
July
2009 37
07/09
Ideal for finding
steel frames
and studs, steel
bracing and nails
in plaster walls,
this Metal Locator
can also show the
length of the tang
in knife handles,
screwdrivers
and other tools.
As well, it can
discriminate
between ferrous
and non-ferrous
metals.
By JOHN CLARKE
Metal Locator
I
F YOU WANT TO hang pictures,
shelving or mirrors on a plaster wall
in a steel-framed building it is useful to
find where the metal studs are.
You may wish to secure your screws
to the stud or alternatively, you may
wish to avoid the stud and attach directly to the plaster wall using suitable
fasteners. There are also other hidden
items within the wall that should be
located before drilling, such as metal
bracing straps, screws and nails.
With the Metal Locator you can
38 Silicon Chip
find the metal stud positions as well
as any steel bracing, screw heads and
nails. That is, provided the metal is no
deeper than 25mm inside the wall. For
small nails in wooden studs, the Metal
Locator can detect them provided that
the heads are within 10mm of the wall
Specifications
Detection range: up to 25mm from the
underside of the case
Current drain: <20mA with LED fully lit
surface. Naturally, this device does not
locate the timber studs themselves, nor
can it find steel frames in walls that
have a cladding thicker than 25mm (a
very unusual wall, especially inside!).
Nor can it detect power cables inside
walls.
The Metal Locator can also distinguish between ferrous and non-ferrous
metals. Ferrous metals include mild
steel, stainless steel (both magnetic
and non-magnetic), wrought iron, high
tensile steel, galvanised iron, tin plated
siliconchip.com.au
as voltage changes that can easily be
amplified before driving the LED. The
LED brightness varies with a change
in frequency from the oscillator. An
offset adjustment using VR1 allows
the LED brightness to be set at a very
low level to brighten with non-ferrous
metals. The LED can be set at a higher
level to detect ferrous metals where
the LED begins to dim.
The buffer stage (IC2b) between the
offset control and the amplifier is there
to ensure there is no gain change with
adjustment of VR1.
BUFFER
(IC2b)
OFFSET
ADJUST
VR1
AMPLIFIER
(IC2a)
FREQUENCY
TO VOLTAGE
CONVERTER
OSCILLATOR
(IC1)
LED & DRIVER
(LED1, Q1)
(C1,C2,D1,D2,VR2)
DETECTOR
COIL
(L1)
Fig.1: the block diagram has the same functionality as the circuit below.
steel (steel cans or tinplate), passivated
steels and cast iron. Non-ferrous metals
include copper, brass, zinc, aluminium, gold, silver, lead and tin.
In the presence of ferrous metals,
the LED on the Metal Locator dims.
Conversely, the LED brightens in the
presence of non-ferrous metal. For
ferrous metals, the sensitivity knob is
adjusted so that the LED is reasonably
bright in the absence of the metal. The
LED then dims in the presence of ferrous metal. To detect non-ferrous metals, the sensitivity is adjusted so that
the LED is dim in the absence of the
metal. The LED will then brighten in
the presence of the non-ferrous metal.
Greater sensitivity can be had with
the LED just glowing in the absence of
metal for detection of either metal type.
The Metal Locator is housed in a
compact plastic case that includes a 9V
battery compartment. On the lid are the
on/off switch, sensitivity control and
the indicating LED.
Circuit details
The circuit in Fig.2 is based on just
two ICs. One is a CMOS version of
the 555 timer (IC1) and the other is a
general-purpose LM358 dual op amp
(IC2a and IC2b).
IC1 operates as an unconventional
astable oscillator. To explain how it
works, we will compare it to a conventional 555 astable oscillator, as shown
in Fig.3. This has resistor R1 between
its output at pin 3 and both the trigger
and threshold inputs at pins 2 and 6.
Capacitor Cx is connected between pins
2 & 6 and ground.
Initially, when power is first applied,
the capacitor is discharged and the trigger input at pin 2 is at 0V. At this stage
How it works
Fig.1 shows the block diagram of the
Metal Locator. It is based on an astable
oscillator controlled by the detector
coil, L1. The oscillation frequency
changes with the presence of metal.
For ferrous metals, the frequency decreases while for non-ferrous metals
the frequency increases.
The oscillator’s output is fed to a
frequency to voltage converter. Small
frequency changes are then detected
REG1 78L05
+5V
OUT
180k
10 F
VR1
ADJUST
1k
OFFSET
LIN
10 F
10
K
7
IC2b
D3
1N4004
A
LED1
180k
100nF
100 F
16V
8
5
6
IN
GND
S1 POWER
ON
IC2: LM358
BUFFER
A
K
1k
8
4
IC1
7555
C1
3
6
C1,C2 CHARGE
D2
10nF
L1
A
C1
DISCHARGE
2
1
R1
470
OSCILLATOR
2
C2
DISCHARGE
3
K
K
C2
100nF
D1
VR2
10k
A
C
Q1
BC337
9V
BATTERY
E
TP1
470
TPG
FREQUENCY-TO-VOLTAGE CONVERTER
METAL LOCATOR
B
470k
AMPLIFIER
IC1, IC2
LED DRIVER
4
8
1
D1,D2: 1N4148
A
SC
1
4
INDUCTOR L1: 400 TURNS OF 0.25mm ENAMELLED
COPPER WIRE ON 20.5mm OD BOBBIN
2009
IC2a
A
K
BC337
LED
K
D3: 1N4004
K
A
78L05
GND
B
E
C
IN
OUT
Fig.2: the Metal Locator circuit is based on two low-cost ICs and a handful of other cheap components.
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 39
+5V
8
4
OUT
3
7555 TRIG 2
THRESH
R1
6
1
SQUARE WAVE
OUTPUT
Cx
Fig.3: here’s a “traditional”
555 oscillator circuit with the
frequency determined by R1 and
CX. But as you can see in Fig.2, it’s
possible to substitute an inductor
and resistor to make it oscillate.
the timer is triggered and the output at
pin 3 goes high to equal the positive
supply rail voltage.
The capacitor now charges via R1.
When the capacitor charges to the pin
6 threshold voltage (2/3 supply), the
pin 3 output goes low (to 0V) and the
capacitor now discharges via R1. When
the capacitor voltage discharges to the
trigger level voltage at pin 2 at 1/3 the
supply, the pin 3 output goes high again
to recharge the Cx capacitor. The process continues and so pin 3 produces a
square wave output with the frequency
determined by R1 and Cx.
In the circuit of Fig.2, we substitute
inductor L1 for R1 and R1 (470Ω) for
capacitor Cx. It now operates as follows. At the instant of power being
applied, inductor L1 is effectively a
And here’s the
proof! The top
trace is the
waveform at pin
3 while the green
trace shows the
waveform at pin 6.
The waveform at
pin 6 is the voltage
across R1 and this
shows that the
current through
R1 does not
reverse; it merely
varies between
about 3.5mA and
7mA. Note the
spikes generated
each time the 555
changes state.
high impedance and resistor R1 pulls
the pin 2 input below the 1/3 supply
threshold to trigger the pin 3 output
to go high.
Current then begins to flow through
L1 and R1. As the current rises, the
voltage across R1 increases until it
reaches the 2/3 supply voltage threshold. This changes the state of the
oscillator so that pin 3 goes low. The
current through L1 does not change
direction but ramps down until the
voltage across R1 drops below the 1/3
supply threshold to retrigger the timer
and pin 3 goes high again.
The frequency is dependent upon
the inductance of L1 and the resistance
of R1 (which is fixed at 470Ω). L1 is an
air-cored coil of wire. If metal comes
close to this coil its inductance will
Why Not Use A Stud Finder?
Most readers know that stud finders
are cheaply available from hardware
outlets such as Bunnings and even
from bargain stores. They often
have three functions: stud, nail
and power.
While they are cheap
and readily available, they
can give misleading results when looking for
screws or metal studs
in walls.
Nor can they
discriminate between ferrous
and non-ferrous
metals and their
sensitivity cannot
be adjusted.
40 Silicon Chip
change and this will alter the frequency
of oscillation. For ferrous metals the
inductance will increase and the
frequency of oscillation will fall. For
non-ferrous metal, the inductance will
decrease and the oscillation frequency
will increase. The frequency is around
94kHz and changes by up to 2kHz with
metal near the coil.
The output from IC1 is fed to a diode
pump comprising capacitors C1 & C2,
resistor VR2 and diodes D1 & D2. It
functions as a frequency-to-voltage
converter by dint of the size of C1
which is fairly small at only 10nF. This
means that the DC voltage developed
across C2 will vary as the frequency
varies; it will be higher as the frequency
increases and this allows the circuit
to discriminate between ferrous and
non-ferrous metals as the apparent
inductance of L1 is changed.
The DC voltage across C2 is amplified by op amp IC2a. This has a gain of
about 470 (471 to be precise), set by the
1kΩ and 470kΩ feedback resistors. IC2a
is buffered by transistor Q1 to provide
a higher current drive for LED1.
Offset control
Op amp IC2a has an offset adjustment to enable adjustment of the LED
brightness. In effect, the operating
point of IC2a can be shifted up or down
by varying the voltage applied to its
inverting input. The varying voltage
comes from IC2b, a unity-gain buffer
which is fed by the wiper of the 1kΩ
potentiometer VR1. Combined with
the 180kΩ divider resistors, the range
amounts to about 14mV.
The buffer stage of IC2b ensures the
gain of IC2a is kept at 471 and is not
siliconchip.com.au
D2
D1
C2
C1
10nF 100nF
TPG S1
4148
LATE M
R OTA C OL
9V BATTERY
CABLE
TIE
100F
4148
REG1
F
470
VR2 10k
CON1
10
IC1
7555
PICAXE
4004
–
TP1
100nF
D3
++
R1
with
180k
LED1
A
JOIN THE TECHNOLOGY
AGE NOW
-
L1
180k
VR1
1k LIN
Q1
K
10F
10
470k
1k
470
04207091
IC2
LM358
10 F
100 F
10 F
Fig.4 (top) shows
the component
layout for the Metal
Locator, with the
same-size photo prior
to mounting in the
case at left. Note the
electrolytic capacitors
need to be mounted
folded over so they
are flat on the PC
board.
affected by the resistance at the wiper
of VR1. Any voltage change in VR1 is
amplified in IC2a by 471, so the 14mV
variation allows the IC2a output to be
shifted over its full output range, from
very close to 0V up to about 3.5V.
This adjustment allows the LED to be
set at the required brightness for metal
detection. In effect, VR1 operates as a
sensitivity control for the circuit.
Trimpot VR2 provides a further
range of adjustment. For optimum operation of VR1, VR2 is adjusted so the
Developed as a teaching tool,
the PICAXE is a low-cost “brain”
for almost any project
voltage at TP1 is at about half supply
or +2.5V. This matches the nominal
2.5V available from the wiper of VR1
at its centre position.
The circuit is powered from 5V,
derived from a 9V battery and a 5V
regulator (REG1). Diode D3 prevents
damage to the 100µF capacitor and the
5V regulator if the battery is connected
the wrong way around. The 5V supply
is decoupled with a 10µF capacitor at
REG1’s output and another 10µF capacitor at the supply rails for IC2. IC1
Easy to use and understand,
professionals & hobbyists can
be productive within minutes.
Free software development
system and low-cost in-circuit
programming.
Variety of hardware, project
boards and kits to suit your
application.
Digital, analog, RS232,
1-Wire™, SPI, and I2C.
PC connectivity.
Applications include:
Datalogging
Robotics
Measurement & instruments
Motor & lighting control
Farming & agriculture
Internet server
Wireless links
Colour sensing
Fun games
How Safe Is That Kitchen Knife?
The handles on some kitchen knives are unsafe because they have a very short
tang. The Metal Locator can show just how long the metal tang goes into the handle
of a kitchen knife or screwdriver. Many professional knives have the tang extending
the whole length of the handles and this tang can be seen running in between the two
handle sections that are riveted to the outside of the tang.
But some low cost knives only have a tang that enters part way into a plastic
moulded handle. They can even have imitation rivets along the handle length to give
the impression that the tang runs along the whole handle length. A short tang means
that a large amount of stress is applied to the handle when using the knife and it is
liable to break. This can be dangerous, especially when doing heavy work such as
cutting up pumpkins. Make sure you use a knife that is safe for the job.
siliconchip.com.au
Distributed in Australia by
Microzed Computers
Pty Limited
Phone 1300 735 420
Fax 1300 735 421
www.microzed.com.au
July 2009 41
Parts List – Metal Locator
1 PC board, code 04207091,
78 x 64mm
1 remote control case 135 x 70
x 24mm (Jaycar HB 5610 or
equivalent)
1 front panel label 50 x 115mm
1 9V battery
1 9V battery snap
1 DPDT PC mount slider switch
(Jaycar SS-0823 or equivalent;
S1)
1 coil bobbin 20.5mm OD x 13mm
ID x 10.5mm high
1 13m length of 0.25mm enamelled copper wire
1 knob to suit potentiometer
1 2-way screw terminals with
5.08mm pin spacing
4 T0-220 insulating bushes (used
as spacers)
4 M3 x 4mm screws
1 20mm diameter x 12mm heatshrink tubing
1 100mm cable tie
9 PC stakes
Semiconductors
1 7555, LMC555CN CMOS timer
(IC1)
1 LM358 dual op amp (IC2)
1 78L05 three terminal 5V
low-power regulator (REG1)
1 BC337 NPN transistor (Q1)
1 1N4004 1A diode (D1)
2 1N4148 signal diodes (D2,D3)
1 3mm high brightness red LED
(LED1)
Capacitors
1 100µF 16V PC electrolytic
2 10µF 16V PC electrolytic
2 100nF MKT polyester
1 10nF MKT polyester
Resistors (1% 0.25W)
1 470kΩ
2 180kΩ
1 1kΩ
2 470Ω
1 10Ω
1 1kΩ linear 16mm potentiometer
(VR1)
1 10kΩ 25-turn top-adjust trimpot
(3296W type) (Code 103) (VR2)
Here’s the completed PC board
screwed into the plastic “remote
control” case. The coil is not attached
to the PC board – it is glued in place
to the case in the cutout provided in
the PC board.
has a 100nF supply bypass capacitor.
Construction
Construction involves mounting all
parts, except coil L1, on a single PC
board. This is coded 04207091 and
measures 78 x 64mm and is housed in
a remote control case measuring 135 x
70 x 24mm.
Fig.4 shows the overlay diagram.
Begin by checking the PC board for
shorted tracks or breaks in the copper.
Check the hole sizes as well. The corner mounting holes should be 3.5mm
(9/64”) in diameter, as can the two
holes to anchor the battery snap leads
with the cable tie. Power switch S1 also
RESISTOR COLOUR CODES
No. Value
1 470kΩ
2 180kΩ
1
1kΩ
2
470Ω
1
10Ω
1
1
1
1
1
4-Band Code (1%)
yellow violet yellow brown
brown grey yellow brown
brown black red brown
yellow violet brown brown
brown black black brown
42 Silicon Chip
5-Band Code (1%)
yellow violet black orange brown
brown grey black orange brown
brown black black brown brown
yellow violet black black brown
brown black black gold brown
mounts on the board – before assembly
check that its holes are large enough
and if not, enlarge slightly.
Now you can begin the assembly.
Install the seven resistors first. We show
their colour codes in a table but it is a
good idea to also check the values using
a digital multimeter before installing
each onto the PC board. Make sure you
don’t mix up the side-by-side 470Ω and
470kΩ resistors. Doing so may not let
any smoke out but it certainly won’t
work when completed, either!
Next, install the five PC stakes for
VR1, the two stakes to terminate inductor L1 and the two stakes for test
points TP1 and TP GND. Install diodes
D1 to D3 and take care to orient these
correctly. IC1 and IC2 can be installed,
making sure that the 7555 timer is
placed in the IC1 position and LM358
in IC2. Each IC must be oriented with
the notch as shown on the overlay
diagram. You might find some ICs don’t
have a notch but will have a small
dimple marking pin 1.
Q1 and REG1 can then be installed
but make sure each is placed correctly,
as they look very similar to each other.
LED1 can be installed, again taking
care to get the orientation correct. The
top of the LED should be 15mm above
the PC board. Next, the capacitors can
be installed. The three electrolytic
types need to be oriented with the polarity shown but they also need to lie
down to provide clearance in the box. A
capacitor code table is provided to help
identify the 100nF and 10nF capacitors.
Trimpot VR2 can be installed either
way around. Switch S1 is mounted as
high as possible on the PC board but
with about 1mm of pin length under
the PC board to allow soldering. CON1
can now be installed.
Cut the shaft of the 1kΩ potentiometer (VR1) to a length of 12mm. VR1
sits vertically with its back on the PC
board surface and is secured in place
by soldering the potentiometer case
to the associated PC stakes. So that
solder will adhere to the surface the
passivated coating on the pot case must
be removed by scraping with a knife or
file where the PC stakes are positioned.
The potentiometer terminals are soldered to the remaining three PC stakes.
The 9V battery leads pass through
one of the battery compartment holes
in the plastic case before inserting them
into the screw terminals. A cable tie
secures the wires in position.
The PC board is raised by about 1mm
siliconchip.com.au
Target
Ferrous metals: LED dims
Non-ferrous metals: LED brightens
Helping to put you in Control
Control Equipment
A close-up of the coil (L1). It’s about
400 turns of wire on a plastic bobbin.
Adjust for partial LED brightness
away from any metal
ON
L
A
T
E
M
R
O
T
A
LOC
SILICON
CHIP
siliconchip.com.au
This full-size front panel artwork
fits into the recess on the top of
the remote control case.
by placing a TO-220 bush into each
mounting hole from the underside of
the PC board. This raises the PC board
sufficiently so the switch slider is
above the top of the case lid.
Secure the PC board to the case with
four M3 screws that screw into the
integral support bushes of the case.
Winding the inductor
Inductor L1 is wound with 400 turns
of 0.25mm enamelled copper wire on
a plastic bobbin. The windings are
jumble wound. This means windings
do not have to be placed neatly sideby-side, layer-by-layer.
The winding is held in place with
a 12mm length of 20mm heatshrink
tubing over the outside of the bobbin.
There is no need to shrink the tubing
down.
The bobbin is secured to the base of
CAPACITOR CODES
Value µF Value IEC Code EIA Code
100nF 0.1µF
100n
104
10nF .001µF
10n
103
siliconchip.com.au
the case in the cut-out area reserved
for it at the front of the PC board. We
used silicone sealant to glue the bobbin in place.
Scrape off the enamel coating on
each wire end with some fine grade
abrasive paper and then solder them to
the two PC stake terminals – it doesn’t
matter which way around.
Test & set-up
Apply power and check that there is
5V between TP GND and pin 4 & 8 of
IC1 and 5V between TP GND and pin
8 of IC2. Depending on the regulator,
the voltage could be anywhere between
4.85 and 5.15V.
Connect your multimeter between
TP GND and TP1 and adjust trimpot
VR2 for a reading of about 2.5V. Now
set VR1 to its centre position and adjust
VR2 until the LED just lights.
Using it
When the Metal Locator is first
switched on and the LED is adjusted
so that it glows dimly, there is a start
up drift over about 10 seconds. During
this period the adjustment will have
to be altered to track the change in
LED brightness. It is best to wait for
the warm up period before using the
Metal Locator.
As mentioned the sensitive area is
directly under the target printed on the
top side of the case (which of course
lines up with the middle of coil L1).
So for detecting metal in a plaster wall,
the case is slid over the wall to detect
a change in the LED brightness.
The adjust knob will need to be set
to show some LED brightness in the
absence of metal objects. The sensitivity to metal is dependent on this
adjustment.
If the LED brightness is set too high
then there will not be a noticeable
change in brightness with the unit in
proximity to a metallic object.
The LED will dim for ferrous and
SC
brighten for non-ferrous metals.
Joysticks
We are
now selling
a selection
of quality
Arcade
style joysticks. From $27.50+GST
VPacks
Looking for an easy
way to get a regulated 3.3V or 5 V
from your AA or AAA
batteries, These
battery holders come with a step-up DCto-DC converter on the back.
From $17.50+GST
Mounting Hubs
Universal aluminum
mounting hubs allow you
to mount custom wheels
and mechanisms to 3, 4
and 6 mm motor shafts.
The hubs are sold in
pairs, and each hub
includes a set screw for securing a motor shaft to the hub. From $11.95+GST
Serial LCD
SerLCD v2.5 supports 16
and 20 character wide
screens with 2 or 4 lines
of display. Contrast control is implemented
through a trim pot on the module. Comes
with 3-pin screw terminal. Adjustable
baud rates 2400 to 38400
From $26.95+GST
Labjack U6
DAQ
A new high
performance
USB Data
acquisition module.It features 14 analog
inputs (16- to 18- bit), 2 analog outputs
(12-bit), 20 digital I/O, 2 counters, and 4
timers. Comes with DaqFactory software
and drivers for Windows and Labview.
$475+GST
RS485 Converter
This simple RS232 to
RS485 non isolated
converter features an
auto baud rate up to
115200bps. $59.95+GST
Contact Ocean Controls
Ph: 03 9782 5882
www.oceancontrols.com.au
July 2009 43
SERVICEMAN'S LOG
Car Electronics: A Whole New Ballgame
As a change this month, a colleague of
mine is going to talk about the confusion
electronic systems in cars can cause. After
all, when it comes to cars, everyone’s an
expert (or has a mate who thinks he is). I’ll
let him tell the story in his own words.
This month, the regular Serviceman
has deputised me to fill in for him. He
is taking a well-earned break, away
from the soldering flux fumes, the
blinding oscilloscope screens and his
multimeter readouts.
Having had a good grounding in
domestic electronics and 2-way communications, I have now owned and
managed an automotive repair workshop for over 30 years. We specialise in
electronics in cars in general and EFI
in particular and my earlier training
gives me a head-start over other mechanics when it comes to diagnosing
problems in these areas. As a result, I
tend to get all the “too hard” jobs that
other workshops have attempted but
have been unable to resolve, often after
many hours of work.
One of the most annoying things
about clients in the auto repair game
is trying to diagnose faults based on
the information given by the said client. If you go to your local GP for any
health issue, you don’t tell him which
procedure you would like performed
on your body. You certainly wouldn’t
consider telling the doctor that you
wanted your appendix removed, just
because you had pain in that area, or
having your knee cartilage scraped
because your mate told you it needed
to be done.
However, when it comes to cars,
most owners become instant experts
and that certainly applies when it
comes to the electronic systems and
components. Many clients bring their
car in and ask us to clean the injectors
or to “tune” the engine, without telling
us what the actual problem is. Another
common request is to have the ABS
(anti-lock braking system) diagnosed
and overhauled. I have also lost count
of those who simply want the car’s
ECU diagnostic codes read and/or
printed out, without mentioning why
they need this information.
Life for the automotive technician
(a 21st century car mechanic) would
be much easier if customers would
simply come in and tell us, in plain
English, what the real problem is,
instead of muttering about ECU codes
and other mumbo-jumbo that they
don’t really understand. Why not
just say “the car is running roughly”,
or “it’s using too much fuel” or “the
engine stalls in traffic”, or “the car
shakes when the brakes are applied”.
The technician could then check that
section of the car concerned, diagnose
the problem and quote on a repair
based on his skill and experience,
rather than on the “gut feel” of the
owner or the “expertise” of his mate.
Blaming the injectors
Perhaps because their operation is
relatively easy to understand, the poor
old EFI fuel injectors cop the blame for
all sorts of problems – everything from
excessive fuel consumption, to engine
misfiring when hot, to intermittent nostart situations. The simple facts are,
they cannot affect any of these.
The “excess fuel usage” problem
is a myth originating from the days
of diesel injectors wearing out, in the
process causing the emission of black
exhaust smoke and heavy fuel consumption. By contrast, EFI injectors do
not “wear”; instead they actually clog
up with deposits. This in turn restricts
the fuel flow which means that they
actually go “lean”, not “rich”.
Partially clogged injectors only really cause issues when cold, a lean
misfire being the most common. These
44 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
brakes and automatic transmissions
not achieving their normal full range
of gear shifting.
Fixing a Camry
problems all but disappear once the
engine is up to operating temperature.
Excess fuel usage has so many
causes that one could write a book
about it. However, if it is suspected,
the first thing that needs to be established is what that actual consumption
figure is. An interesting anomaly is
that such complaints increase markedly as the price of petrol increases.
In fact, it is invariably just the dollar
consumption that increases, not the
litres consumption.
That aside, if increased fuel usage is
a problem, the first step is to establish
how many litres the vehicle is consuming for every 100km kilometres
travelled (l/100km). To cut a long story
short, any electronic causes of excess
fuel usage that don’t also cause other
driveability issues are usually limited
to the failure of the oxygen sensor (or
sensors in some cars).
ECU failure, wiring issues and failures in other sensors are relatively rare
on properly serviced cars that have
done less than 250,000-300,000km.
However, oxygen sensors are similar
to spark plugs in that they have a finite
life. Most have outlived their serviceable life by 150,000km.
Even so, the most common causes
of heavy fuel consumption are more
mundane and include things such as
spark plugs, leads, coils, fuel pressure
regulators and driver behaviour. Other
causes include mechanical issues
such as low tyre pressures, dragging
We had a 1998 Toyota Camry 4-cylinder come in recently, its owner complaining that he had already spent his
last two weeks pay having the injectors
removed and cleaned, the ECU bench
tested and numerous parts replaced,
including various filters, the air-flow
meter, the coolant temperature sensor,
the fuel pump and the spark plugs.
This work had all been done by a
local mechanic at his insistence, in
an effort to reduce the mysterious
disappearance of extra litres of the precious petroleum liquid. Fortunately,
he revealed all this to us before work
commenced and he was actually asking us for advice rather than relying
on his own skills.
Checking the basics quickly revealed a non-responsive oxygen sensor
and tyres that were running very low
inflation pressures. Low tyre pressures
cause problems in two ways: (1) by
increasing the rolling resistance (drag);
and (2) by lowering of the overall gear
Wanted: Electronics Technician
An experienced electronics technician is required to repair & overhaul
complex electronics equipment in our modern Hornsby workshop.
Email your application to:
ELECTRONICS SPECIALISTS
TO INDUSTRY AND DEFENCE
siliconchip.com.au
SWITCHMODE POWER SUPPLIES PTY LTD (ABN 54 003 958 030)
1/37 Leighton Place, Hornsby, NSW 2077.
email: martin.griffith<at>switchmode.com.au
Phone (02) 9476 0300
webpage: www.switchmode.com.au
July 2009 45
Serr v ice
Se
ceman’s
man’s Log – continued
ratio (not to be underestimated). Some
complimentary fresh air, a new oxygen
sensor and an invoice for $297 put a
happy customer back on the road in
quick time.
Look for the obvious
A similar scenario was played a
few months ago on a 10-year old VT
Commodore Executive. A colleague
from the northern suburbs who wasn’t
“full-bottle” on ABS electronics re
commended the owner to us. The
symptoms were violent vibrations
through the steering wheel under
heavy braking. In our colleague’s
defence, he hadn’t driven the car and
was only asked to diagnose the problem after the owner had already spent
his hard-earned dollars elsewhere, to
no avail. He didn’t have the time (or
perhaps the inclination) to attempt the
job, so he passed it on to us.
The original repairer had replaced
the entire ABS actuator and module
assembly, along with all four wheelsensors (at a 4-figure sum). They had
then pressure-bled the entire system
after a cursory examination of the
brakes themselves. However, there was
no indication (using diagnostic scanners or otherwise) that there were any
ABS issues at all. The repairer should
have had a closer look at the badly
cracked, undersize and discoloured
front disc rotors before assuming the
worst.
A new pair of front rotors and better
46 Silicon Chip
quality pads solved his hideous brake
issues and saw the owner on his way.
Common sensor problems
Simply measuring in-circuit voltages or looking at sensor output
waveforms are the easiest and best
forms of diagnosis for many electronic
problems in cars. However, many
technicians depend heavily on reading built-in diagnostic fault codes
and measuring individual sensors
out of circuit, without checking the
basics first.
One of the most common sensor
“failures” is that of an open circuit in
the coolant temperature circuit. It is
always assumed that the poor old sensor is the culprit and so it is often just
replaced as a matter of course, without
measuring any voltages.
Some of the more “clever” technicians first unplug the “offending” sensor and measure its internal resistance.
The technician is then mystified. If the
sensor is OK, why does the ECU throw
up a code for a faulty sensor? Well, the
ECU hasn’t actually condemned the
coolant sensor; all the dumb processor
knows is that the voltage in that loop
is abnormally high and therefore the
circuit appears to be open.
The most common single fault in
these instances is simply a corroded
or loose connector plug at the sensor.
The various plugs and connectors in
the engine bay live in a very hostile
environment, with oil, water, excess
heat and vibration present year in and
year out. When compared to those that
live in static, domestic surroundings,
it’s not hard to understand why they
sometimes fail. Virtually all EFI systems since the year dot have an engine
temperature sensor of some type (usually measuring coolant temperature),
so these problems have been around
for two generations and yet are still
wrongly diagnosed.
Another common cause of electronic maladies in the automotive field is
that of faulty earth circuits. An engine
is often not “earthed” very well. After
all, the power plant is usually mounted
on neoprene rubber mounts with some
fairly ordinary earth links back to the
body and/or chassis.
In years gone by, this wasn’t a major issue, as there weren’t many vital
electrical items involved with engine
operation. As long as the ignition system saw around 12V, the starter motor
had a good supply of heavy current
for starting and the alternator kept
the battery charged, no dramas were
generally seen.
These days, with EFI, ABS, traction control, electronically-controlled
automatic transmissions, drive-bywire throttle control and modules
controlling just about everything in
the car, those missing millivolts are of
the utmost importance. Whether the
cause is deterioration due to wear and
tear or poor wiring design, bad earth
circuits are more common than many
technicians realise. Once again, they
often chase their own backs by using
diagnostic fault codes as the main line
of defence, rather than checking a few
basics first.
If I’m looking for a weird fault in
an automotive electronic system, the
items I always check first are: loose/
corroded battery terminals, any wayward voltage between engine and body
earth, the alternator charge rate and the
operation of all warning lights on the
instrument panel. With oxygen sensors
oscillating either side of 500mV at a
few hertz, a floating earth can negate
its operation completely, yet not illuminate the “check engine light” or
throw up any fault codes. The same
applies to thermistor type sensors.
In cars with boot-mounted batteries,
ECU-controlled alternator regulators
and serial-BUS or CAN-BUS communication between the various control
modules, these up-front basic checks
are essential.
siliconchip.com.au
A few of these BUS systems can have problems of
their own. A commonly seen Bosch ABS system (version 5.3) fitted to many makes of car (everything from
Toyotas, Holdens and Fords to Saabs, VWs and Audis)
has an issue whereby open-circuit internal links not
only cause ABS and traction control problems but also
affect all other ECUs on that BUS line. We’ve had cars
towed into the shop because this “small” ABS drama
has locked the automatic transmission into third gear
only (limp-home mode), switched the engine cooling
fans to full speed and played havoc with all instrument
warning lights and gauges.
In addition, it affects engine ECU operation and
disables the air-conditioning system, making the car
all but undriveable. This problem is now so common
that these ABS modules are available as off-the-shelf
re-manufactured exchange units. Fortunately, the cause
was eliminated in later versions of this ABS system and
so it doesn’t occur in late-model cars.
ECU failure is rare
Engine or transmission ECU failure is a rare event
for the most part but there are exceptions. There are
a handful of popular cars where ECU problems are
to be expected in the medium term, regardless of the
kilometres travelled. For example, some Mitsubishis
manufactured in the 90s have issues with electrolytic
capacitors leaking over the PC board. The leakage permeates the protective lacquer and usually shorts out
copper tracks on the board’s surface. The 12V rail can
short to anything close by and this can be to an earth
track, causing severe charring of the board and all components in that area.
Alternatively, it can short to a 5V rail, often destroying any semiconductors or processors in the vicinity.
Many of these items are custom-designed for the purpose
and therefore unobtainable through normal channels,
deeming the whole ECU an irreparable write-off. In other
cars, the ECUs can suffer from good old dry joint issues
or worse, corrosion from water entry due to a leaking
windscreen or heater core. However, most EFI electronic
siliconchip.com.au
Professionally Designed and engineered
in Australia using Peerless speakers
which are known and respected across
the globe. Remarkable Cross-over design,
built using the highest grade components
designed to give maximum clarity and
responsiveness for voice and
tonal reproduction.
For More Info Please visit:
www.wagner.net.au/speakers
www.d-s-t.com.au/speakerkits
We stock everything you need for your Audio Visual installation
including HDMI & RCA Interconnect, Plasma / LCD TV Wall Brackets,
Speaker cabling, Plugs & Connectors, Tools and Soldering
Equipment, Plus Lots More!! View our Catalogue online.
Visit Us Online: www.wagner.net.au
Email: sales<at>wagner.net.au
July 2009 47
Phone: 02 9798 9233
138 Liverpool Road, Ashfeild, NSW, 2131
Serr v ice
Se
ceman’s
man’s Log – continued
A Strange Problem
Actually, I did manage to sneak one
story in this month, although I must
confess that it’s one that was held
over from the previous issue. It’s one
of the strangest problems I have ever
had to deal with and it involved a set
belonging to a young lady with severe
peripheral vision. In fact, her condition
was so bad that she was classified as
legally blind.
Her problem was that she was having a great deal of difficulty operating
her JVC AV-21BS26 CRT TV. This is a
silver TV with silver-coloured controls,
which made them difficult for her to
recognise. Apart from the flush-fitting
power switch, these controls (Menu,
Channel & Volume) are all hidden
underneath an adjacent flap, which
problems are usually seen under the
bonnet and not in the ECU itself.
Automotive design and their associated electronic systems have advanced
so quickly in the last two decades that,
48 Silicon Chip
only added to her difficulties. In addition, the remote control is all grey, so
it too was difficult for her to operate.
Adding to her woes, the reception
in the Housing Commission village
where she lived was quite poor. As I
later discovered, this was due to the
ancient Concordia coaxial cable used
to distribute the antenna signal. This
cable was also acting like an antenna
and picking up signal, the end result
being leading-edge ghost images.
Finally, every time she changed any
of the control settings on the TV, the
command was accompanied by two
deafening beeps that could be heard
by her neighbours. So that also had
to be solved.
I decided to start with the extremely
annoying loud beep. I couldn’t find a
reference to it in the set’s instruction
book, nor could I initially find it in any
of the OSD menus. However, after
some searching, I eventually found
it in the install menu after scrolling
in my humble opinion, it’s time for a
moratorium on further development to
allow the service and parts industry to
catch up. I know from personal experience that the same issues exist in the
down to reveal two extra items at the
bottom. The first of these items is the
blue screen mute option and the last
one lets you turn off the beep.
There was no easy fix for the aerial
system, except to use a Digital SetTop Box (DSTB). Unfortunately, her
JVC TV had a sloping back, so the
DSTB couldn’t sit on top, which was
rather inconvenient.
Another problem was that in order
to select the TV’s AV input with the
remote, you had to cycle through
all the options until you got to AV1.
Unfortunately, her set did not have
last-state memory, so she would have
to go through that exercise every time
she switched the set on. However, that
just wasn’t practical, because it was
difficult for her to see which input had
been selected each time the mode
button was pressed.
In the end, I swapped her JVC set
for a rather nice Sony KVG-21S1
which I happened to have in the
workshop. This Sony set has a flat
top to rest the DSTB on and can also
start and stop in the AV mode so she
doesn’t have to select it each time. In
short, it was much more convenient
for her to operate.
The DSTB fixed her reception
problems too and I skipped all the
channels she didn’t want with the
exception of Ch4 which is an orange
digital program guide. This gave her
a reference point she could actually
see clearly and from which she could
count sequentially to the program she
wanted.
I contemplated covering the remote
buttons other than on/off, channel up
and down and volume up and down
buttons so that she couldn’t inadvertently press the wrong one. However,
this wasn’t practical and in any case
wasn’t necessary as the customer
sits so close to the set that a remote
control isn’t necessary.
Instead, she came up with her own
simple solution: orange dot stickers on
the Volume and Channel buttons on
the TV, so that the black buttons could
be seen against the black cabinet.
domestic electronics industry, where
service technicians are forever playing catch-up obtaining the necessary
equipment, literature and knowledge
SC
to service the latest gear.
siliconchip.com.au
R
O
F
S
L
TOO YOUR TRADE
Wireless
Weather Station
WOOLOONGABBA STORE
REFURBISHED
STORE
A feature-packed weather station for the enthusiast forecaster. The outdoor sensors
will wirelessly transmit real-time indoor/outdoor temperature, relative humidity, rain,
wind speed, wind chill, dew point, and barometric pressure. All minimum and
maximum values with the date and time it was recorded are stored for your reference.
Along with its storm warning feature, you can set programmable alarms to alert you
when certain weather parameters fall above or below a limit you determine. If you
enjoy outdoor activities this is a great tool to inform you of ideal weather conditions or
to keep you a step ahead of potential hazards.
See our website for full details.
$
149
New Touch Screen Wireless Weather Station with USB also available. This highly
advanced weather station features a touch screen panel that you can connect to your
computer through USB for storage and a more accurate analysis of weather data.
XC-0348 $199
Cat: XC-0346
Coax Connector
Bargains
Surplus Stock Attention Radio Amateurs
A 1.7m length of high-quality 50 ohm coax terminated with a
PL-259 UHF connector & a 4-pole connector with 4 unterminated wires at the other end, all
encased in a flexible PVC jacket. You can easily strip the outer jacket and just have the coax
and connector, and keep the wire (the nicest hookup wire you’ve ever seen in 4 colours)
for your scrap box. Cat. WC-7810 $7.00 (Pk 10)
$
15 Pk 10
Cat: WC-7811
$
7 Pk 10
Cat: WC-7810
The same as above except the coax is 6.2m long and has a
UHF connector and a 4-pole connector at each end. The 4-pole
connectors are male/female. This assembly would be ideal when
you have to switch equipment at the antenna end of a ham rig.
Cat. WC-7811 $15.00 (Pk 10)
Ideal for camping, 4WD, boating,
caravans or motorhome holidays.
Take the guesswork out of
installing your Digital TV
antenna to get the best
signal. With this handy little
signal strength indicator, you
get a clear visual LED
indication of the signal
strength coming from
your antenna as you
adjust the position and
direction. No more yelling from the
roof to the living room! Note colour
may vary from photograph shown.
Size: 80(L) x 66(W) x 32(H)mm
$
499
Cat: ZM-9122
Rack-Mount Dual
DJ CD Player
All the features professional DJs require, like
anti-shock, cue and seamless looping.
$
74
95
Cat: LT-3330
• Backlit LCD • Variable pitch control
$
• Full function IR remote control
• Tactile silicone rubber buttons
Cat: AA-0491
• Compatible with CD, CD-R, CD-RW, MP3
• Anti-shock buffer memory
• Quality Japanese transports
Free Call: 1800 022 888 for orders!
Contents includes sanding
arbours, sanding belts, drill bits,
collets, assorted grinding stones
and polishing wheels with
arbours, TC and diamond burrs,
wire brushes, cutoff wheels,
buffing mop with paste, paint
removing wheel, 250 sanding
discs & more.
69 95
Cat: TD-2456
Take your solar power with you wherever you need it. Folding to a
compact bundle, this versatile monocrystalline solar charger will fit anywhere, but expands to a full size 20
watt solar charger. It has a robust nylon fabric enclosure and cigarette lighter socket for powering whatever
you need. Also includes utility loops so you can tie it up in a convenient place to catch maximum sunlight.
Two lead sets are included - one with a cigarette lighter plug and another that terminates to alligator clips.
Digital TV Signal
Strength Indicator
Much cheaper than the hardware store and with 400
pieces, this kit will service every bit you will ever need.
Housed in a plastic case.
Case measures:
210(W) x 300(H) x 70(D)mm
Folding Solar
Charger 20W
Due Mid July
Rotary Tool Bit
Set - 400PC
$
Note: These cable assemblies were made for a military communications application, are only 3 months old
and are of outstanding quality. Please note that they are only sold in packs of 10 cable assemblies.
• Dimensions:
Open: 965(L) x 362(W) mm
Folded: 375(L) x 120(W) x 45(D)mm
65 Ipswich Rd
Cnr Wilton St
Qld 4102
Ph: (07) 3393 0777
399
Multi-Function
Filter Module
Ref: Silicon Chip
Magazine July 2009
A very versatile active filter
module that could be used as an
active crossover in a speaker
project, a low pass filter for a subwoofer, or a high or band pass filter
simply by changing a couple of jumper links.
Being an active circuit, you'll need to
$
add a power supply (see specifications
on our website) and amplifiers for
the drivers. Short form kit only.
24 95
Cat: KC-5480
Turntable/
CD player
Dust off those old LPs! This
player includes a turntable,
AM/FM stereo radio, cassette
deck and a programmable CD
player all encased in a cherry
wood finish cabinet with two
front stereo speakers. See our
website for specifications.
Plays 12" LPs & 7" EPs records - 3 speeds 33/45/78rpm
• Measures 390(L) x 360(D) x 260(H)mm
• Ask us how to back up your LPs to CD
$
199
Cat: GE-4063
To o l s f o r yo u r Tra d e
TEST & MEASUREMENT
Thermocouple
Thermometer
2 Input Fast response and laboratory
The soldering station
features a high quality
ceramic heating element
for accurate temperature
control, which is
adjustable between 200
and 480°C. The soldering
pencil is light weight, making it
comfortable for use for
extended periods.
accuracy, works with K-type thermocouples
and offers 0.1 or 1° user-selectable
resolution over the entire measurement range.
You can monitor two separate temps or use
the differential function to compare them.
• Auto power off • Backlit LCD
• Max and hold function
• Celsius & Fahrenheit
$
• Holster included
• Thermocouples included
99 95
Cat: QM-1601
Cat III DynamoPowered DMM
This dynamo powered DMM requires no
batteries. Just crank the handle for 10
seconds to provide power for about 10
minutes operation. Ideal for electrical
emergencies on the car or boat. It also
has provision to be powered by 2 x
CR2032 batteries.
$
99 95
• No batteries required
• Capacitance and frequency
• Data hold • 10A current
Cat: QM-1547
Cat IV 600V/
CAT III 1000V DMM
Ergonomically designed slim shape
with one hand operating knob and
buttons. It has overload protection,
easy battery replacement, and is compact,
yet extremely rugged. This DMM would be an
excellent investment for the apprentice to the
professional tradesman.
$
This meter is supplied
with a protective
Cat: QM-1623
holster and test lead.
• Dimensions: 164(L) x 82(W) x 44(D)mm
• Large scale display • Auto power-off
• Display: 4000 count • Category: Cat IV 600V
• Basic DCV accuracy: 0.500%
Cat IV Fixed Jaw
Clampmeter
The ideal test instrument for electrical contractors.
Compact and light with probe storage in the back for
easy one-handed operation. Jaw opening is 16mm.
• Non-contact voltage sensor
$
• Data hold
• Auto power-off
Cat: QM-1567
• Diode test
• Audible continuity test
• Category: Cat IV 600V, Cat III 1000V
• Display: 2000 count
• Dimensions: 190(H) x 62(W) x 42(D)mm
179
This is a full featured meter with plug-in
4mm probes AND transistor tester. It is the
ideal first multimeter and will give years of
faithful service.
$
9 95
• DC Voltage: 200mV
Cat: QM-1500
to 1000V
• DC Amps: 200uA to 10A
• AC Volts: 200V to 750V
• Resistance: 200 ohm to 2M ohms
• Size: 125(H) x 68(W) x 23(D)mm
2
• Temperature Range: 200 - 480°C
• Accuracy: +/-10°C
Ideal for the hobbyist and handy person.
Has a stainless steel barrel and orange cool grip,
impact resistant handle.
13 95
Cat: TS-1465
$
109
Cat: TS-1560
Super Pro Gas
Soldering Tool Kit
Kit contains a Portasol Super Pro Gas Soldering Iron,
and all of the following parts:
$
SOLDERING EQUIPMENT
25 Watt Soldering Iron
$
Spare tip available - TS-1466 $3.95
Gas Soldering Iron /
Torch Kit
Everything you need to solder, silver solder, braze,
heatshrink, strip paint etc. Refillable with stand,
extra tips, torch and cutting attachment.
159
Cat: TS-1328
• Quality storage case • Cleaning sponge & tray
• 2.4mm double flat tip • 4.8mm double flat tip
• Hot air blow
Electrical Tester with
Polarity Checking
and Light
199
Low Cost DMM
50W Temperature
Controlled Soldering
Station
Designed for maximum safety.
The probes have a good grip and are IP64
rated. Testing voltage is simple and the
unit's LED display will indicate to the
nearest voltage up to 690V with polarity
indication. This unit will also check for
low impedance, continuity, do a single
pole phase test and show rotary field
indication. A LED light is included
for dimly lit locations.
$
49 95
Cat: QP-2286
• Requires 2 x AAA batteries (included)
• Voltage test works without batteries
• 3 soldering tips
• 1 torch attachment
• 1 rope cutter
$
39 95
Cat: TS-1112
VOLTAGE DETECTORS
Telescopic AC
Voltage Detector
Test for
mains voltage in confined or inaccessible
areas such as wall and ceiling cavities, behind furniture,
under floors etc. Ideal for shop fitters, chippies,
plumbers and other tradesmen to check that there’s no
nasty surprises before you sink a drill through the
gyprock and end up with an afro or worse - go home
in a pine overcoat. Batteries included. Fold to a handy
pocket size for easy storage.
$
22 95
• LED indicates mains voltage
Cat: QP-2279
• Cat II rated
• Extends to over 1.2m
• Size folded: 180(L) x 32(W) x 16(D)mm
ABS INSTRUMENT CASES - IP65 Rated
These are excellent cases and you will be hard pressed to find a better product anywhere
near the price. Ideal for photographic gear, test and measurement equipment, scientific
and medical equipment etc.
• Each has a soft pluck foam insert with pre-cut squares
that can be removed to snugly fit the item you want to protect.
• The lids are also lined with eggshell foam, and are secured with strong snap
closed fasteners with a gasket seal that is waterproof and dustproof to IP65.
FROM
Four sizes available with 2 year warranty:
MP1 Cat. HB-6380 $49.95
$
MP5 Cat. HB-6384 $139
Internal: 240(W) x 160(H) x 92(D)mm
External: 260(W) x 180(H) x 100(D)mm
Internal: 359(W) x 239(H) x 152(D)mm
External: 380(W) x 260(H) x 160(D)mm
MP3 Cat. HB-6382 $89.95
Internal: 310(W) x 190(H) x 112(D)mm
External: 330(W) x 210(H) x 120(D)mm
MP6 Cat. HB-6386 $159
Internal: 399(W) x 279(H) x 110(D)mm
External: 420(W) x 300(H) x 120(D)mm
49 95
All savings are based on original recommended retail prices.
To o l s f o r yo u r T ra d e
1000V- 7 Piece
Screwdriver Set
High quality, bright
red drivers you can
find easily. Insulated
right to the tip and
rated to 1000V.
Drive sizes:
Flat: 1.2x 6.5 x
150mm, 1 x 5.5 x 125mm,
0.8 x 4 x 100mm, 0.6 x 3.5 x 75mm.
Phillips: #2 x 100mm, #1 x 80mm,
#0 x 60mm. Includes storage box.
29 Piece Tool Kit With Case
DIY minor repairs are a breeze with this 29 piece tool kit and
every DIY guy should have at least one of these in easy reach.
Includes torch.
$
See in-store
or our
website for a
full tool list.
24 95
See website for full listing
$
Cat: TD-2022
6-in-1Compact
Screwdriver
$
34 95
TD-2032 Driver handle to suit $6.95
• Torch requires 2 x AA batteries (not included)
• Case measures 200(L) x 145(W) x 45(H)mm
10 Piece Spanner Set
This innovative screwdriver has six of the most useful
blades. They are made of a vanadium and molybdenum
alloy and stored neatly in the handle. This may just
become one of the handiest tools in your kit. Supplied with
the following blades.
$
95
• Slotted: 4, 5, 6mm
• Phillips: #1, #2, #3
Cat: TD-2028
• 128mm long
18
Ideal mini spanner set.
Set of 10 pieces, open
end/ring combination.
Suitable for light hobby
use.
• Sizes 4, 4.5, 5, 5.5, 6, 7,
8, 9, 10, 11mm
• Supplied in a
plastic wallet
Heavy Duty
Wire Stripper
$
6P/8P Modular Crimp Tool
This tool will crimp 6P2C, 6P4C-RJ11, 6P6CRJ12 &8P-RJ45 plugs. Also cuts
and strips the cable.
$
29
Measure the temperature of a surface
from a safe distance. Dual laser
sighting for accuracy.
$
Temperature range:
-50° to +650°C
Cat: QM-7221
119
95
• Response time: <150ms
• 140mm long
Cat: QM-7217
Flow Rate Sensors
These flowmeters provide simple DC output pulses in proportion
to supply voltage and fluid flow which makes interfacing easy.
Both have impellers made from acetal and stainless steel shafts,
so will work with low viscosity fluids. Two types:
Cat. ZD-1200 $49.95
Cat. ZD-1202 $49.95
For full specifications, see page 29 of our
2009 Catalogue or on our website.
$
49 95
Cat: ZD-1202
$
49
95
Cat: ZD-1200
Cat: TD-2038
Computer Service
Tool Kit
Ideal for computer
service technicians or
the talented amateur.
Kit includes:
IC inserter/extractor,
Pearl Catch, Tweezers,
1/4" Nutdriver, 3/16"
Nutdriver, Double ended
10/15 Torx driver, Parts tube for storage,
#1 & #0 Phillips screwdrivers,
1/8" & 3/16 Slotted screwdrivers,
Zipper case, Size 220 x 155 x 38mm
$
29 95
Cat: TD-2040
All the heatshrink the
technician, tradesman or
serious hobby user will ever
need. The pack contains 160
lengths of different sizes from
1.5 to 10mm in black, red and
clear in a handy storage case.
$
• Case size: 205(L) x 110(W) x 35(H)mm
Non-Contact
Thermometer
with Dual
Laser Targeting
Suitable for lab, chemistry
and industrial
applications. It
measures in Celsius
and Fahrenheit and has a stainless steel probe
and protective cap. Batteries included.
Hall Type
1.5 - 25 litres per minute
Reed Switch 0.6 - 8 litres per minute
19 95
Cat: TH-1935
Probe Thermometer
19 95
Heatshrink
Assortment
Trade Pack
17 95
Cat: TH-1910
Designed for easy wire
stripping of AWG
10-24 gauge
cable (0.13 6.0mm). The
wire guide ensures
the correct length is stripped. A precision blade is
incorporated for easy wire cutting. Also features quality
crimping jaws.
$
95
• For 1.5 - 6mm terminals
• Spring return
Cat: TH-1827
34
This is an excellent driver bit set that
contains just about every bit you could
ever use. It has a magnetic holder,
adaptors, Phillips bits, slotted bits, torx,
tamperproof, pin drive, and even a wing
nut driver - Fantastic.
• Metric and Imperial sizes
Cat: TD-2066
• Auto power-off and low battery indication
• Data hold
$
• Range: -50 - 270°C. (-58 - 518°F)
• Resolution: 0.1°C (1°F)
• Accuracy: 1.5%
• Dimensions: 185(L) x 36(W) x 19(H)mm
100 Piece Driver Bit Set
24 95
Cat: WH-5524
THERMOMETERS
IR Non-Contact Pocket
Thermometer
Take quick and accurate temperature measurements of any
surface without touching it. Handy for the house or garage.
LCD displays temperature in Celsius
and acquires a
reading in less
than two
seconds.
• Accuracy: ±1% • Range: -50 - 220°C
• Handy pocket clip • Batteries included
• Size: 85(L) x 15(Dia)mm
$
49 95
Cat: QM-7219
Electronic Flow
Rate Meter with LCD
Completely self-contained, this unit only measures
60 x 40mm and includes a full LCD information display.
It's supplied with a reed switch and piezo alarm. It operates
from 2 x AAA batteries and a battery holder is included.
When used in conjunction with the FS-300AH Digital
Flowmeter (Cat ZD-1202), it will count down (in litres) from
a predetermined volume, for example 500 litres. When 500
litres have gone through the flowmeter an alarm will sound.
The alarm signal can be used to trigger another slave device. As
it goes up to 99,500 litres, it could be used in larger-scale applications
such as irrigation or just to let you know when it's time to clean a filter. It
also reads flow rate, will remember data and operate in time
mode. An unbelievably fantastic product!
• Full data sheet & instructions included
• PCB/LCD size: 60(L) x 40(W)mm
Free Call: 1800 022 888 for orders! www.jaycar.com.au
$
69 95
Cat: ZD-1204
3
Great Gift Ideas for Christmas in July!
1:12 Scale Casey
Stoner RC Motorbike
4 Channel Mini RC Helicopter
with Remote Recharge
For the Motorbike Enthusiast!
The smallest 4 channel RC helicopter on the market, this little
beauty is a joy to fly. Surprisingly easy to control and stable in
flight, it comes ready assembled with a true 4 channel remote.
Running low on power? Just simply attach the
helicopter to the IR remote to recharge it for
17 minutes, and you're up, up and away again.
A replica of Casey Stoner's 2007 Moto GP Championshipwinning 800cc Duke with full function digital proportional
remote control. It also has a fully functional
replica Casey on board who leans into
every corner like a real rider. A highly
detailed model complete with slick
tyres, working front and rear
suspension and display stand.
• Steering trim alignment
• Brake endpoint adjustment
• Throttle curve selector
• 27MHz
• Measures 175(L)mm
• Suitable for ages 10+
• 17 minutes recharge for 5-7 mins flight time
• Weighs 19g, 190mm long (220mm inc. blades)
• Requires 6 x AA batteries
• Suitable for ages 14+
$
19
$10
39 95
Cat: GT-3276
• Requires 6 x AA batteries
• Wingspan: 310mm
• Suitable for ages 8+
Was $49.95
Forget about reading National
Geographic while you're indisposed just play with the sudoku loo roll!
After you've finished, put it
to good use!
• Double ply for comfort
USB Missile Launcher
with Web Cam
Upgrade to the latest in workstation weapons.
This USB missile launcher is
equipped with a detachable webcam
and software, which allows you to
communicate via the MSN Instant
Messenger service. Also now
with added sound effects!
$20
$
89
Cat: GE-4084
$
14
95
Cat: GE-4089
Was $19.95
*Laptop not included
4
$
$
199
29 95
Cat: GH-1122
Cat: GH-1372
Create a dazzling lighting effect with this USB
powered plasma ball that will surely impress your
colleagues! As the ball becomes energised, the gases
inside light up and turn into plasma. By touching the
outside of the ball, you can produce amazing effects.
System requirements:
• Windows XP or Mac OS X
• USB 1.1 port
• Measures: 130(H) x 100(W)mm
Cat: GT-3263
• Requires 4 x AAA batteries
• Handy belt clip
• Up to 130 x magnification
• USB powered
• Approx 150mm tall
• Up to 640 x 480 image resolution
• 5 x optical zoom
Was $99
USB Plasma Ball
169
Next time someone starts going on about synergies,
tipping points, end-state visions and stakeholder
partnering, you can just turn on your Bullsh*t Detector
and shut them up with one of nine
anti-bullsh*t messages.
69
Cat: GH-1508
$
Remote Control Bull
SH*T Detector
A terrific introduction to the microscopic world of nature. It
works with your computer by displaying the camera's output
onto your monitor and at the press of a
button you can
$
capture the digital
images for projects etc.
Cat: QC-3244
5 95
• 3 foam WMDs inlcluded
• Shoots up to 5 metres
• 110(W) x 125(D) x 185(H)mm
Limited Stock Was $109
Store your best wine
and keep them chilled
in this wine cooler. It
has a capacity of 18L,
holding up to 6 wine
bottles and uses
Peltier thermoelectric
modules to cool the
wine bottles 18 degrees
below ambient
temperature.
• Mains powered
• Power consumption: 56W
• 245(W) x 380(H) x 510(D)mm
USB Digital Microscope
Camera System
Sudoku Toilet Paper
$
GT-3300
GT-3301
GT-3302
GT-3303
GT-3304
GT-3305
6 Bottle Wine Cooler
Generating a lot of lift from the wide rotors gives this slightly
weird machine very stable flight. It's made of durable foam, so
will take a few knocks from dodgy landings and armchair
pilots. 20 minute charge from the remote unit provides about
8 minutes of flying time.
$
• 20 minutes charge gives about 10 minutes flight time
• Rechargeable 7.4V 1000mA Li-Po battery
• Frequency: 40MHz
• Requires 8 x AA batteries
• Recommended for ages 10+
Spare Parts Available
• 7.4V 1000mAh Rechargeable
Battery
$44.95
• Stabiliser Bar Pk 2 $6.95
• Gear Shaft B
$9.95
• Drive Gear
$4.95
• Tail Rotor Rack
$6.95
• Connecting Buckle $1.00
Remote Control UFO
Cat: GT-3279
Four channels gives you the full range of control - up/down, forward/back, backleft/right, and rotate-left/right. Finished in jungle camo.
149
$5
Not just a display piece, this 1:64 scale
F430 Ferrari has rear wheel drive an
adjustable steering bias to ensure a straight
and smooth ride. It is finished in Ferrari red
with remote control stored in display base.
• Requires 6 x AA batteries
• Recharges from display base
$
95
• Suitable for ages 10+
Cat: GT-3213
Was $24.95
79 95
Apache 4 Channel RC Helicopter
Cat: GT-3690
RC Miniature
F430 Ferrari
$
$30
Alien Doorbell
Who's at the door? A friend, or an invasion of aliens? When
someone comes calling, the flying saucer speaker will deliver
noises of a spaceship landing
or an alien greeting.
• Requires 1 x 9V, 4 x AA
batteries
• Indoor use only.
• Suitable for ages 5+
Was $39.95
$
$10
29 95
Cat: LA-5019
$5
USB Ultrasonic
Cool Mist Humidifier
Not only can it help reduce allergens, it also
keeps the skin hydrated making you look & feel
younger. Simply plug into your
computer's USB port to keep
you fresh & alert day after day.
• Unit measures: 90(L) x
83(W) x 128(H)mm
Limited Stock
Was $39.95
$
29 95
Cat: YH-5460
All savings are based on original recommended retail prices.
$10
Great Gif t Ideas For Christmas In July!
USB Slide/Film Scanner
DIGITAL PHOTO FRAMES
3.5" Digital
Photo Frame
$10
Displays single frame photos or slideshows, this mini
Convert your negatives and slides to digital images quickly and
easily with this USB scanner. Images are scanned in about half
a second for high-speed conversion & editing using the
included Arcsoft Photoimpression software or one of
many other image management programs.
• Colour or B&W film or slides
• Negative & slide holders included
• 1,800 dpi resolution
• Windows XP, Vista
$
199
digital photo frame is ideal for your desk at work or
home and can read from an SD or MMC card up to
2GB. USB or mains powered.
Cat: XC-4881
• Supports JPEG image format
• Plugpack included
• Size: 108(W) x 84(H) x 20(D)mm
USB 2.0 DVD Maker
Turn your aging collection of VHS and Betamax
video tapes into new video productions or record
live video straight to your DVD or CD burner. This
new and improved version works with a Mac
& Windows, allowing you to publish your videos
on to web application and many more features.
$
Cat: QM-3779
Limited Stock
Display your favourite photos or videos. You
can control all of the functions with the
remote control or leave the automatic slide
show display running. USB or mains powered.
99
$
Plug in your iPod® or iPhone® and listen to music through
your car's FM radio. If you get a call, you use the phone
hands-free without losing the music.
• 16:9 aspect ratio
• SD/MMC/MS card compatible
• Supports JPEG format
• Supports MPEG1, MPEG2 and MPEG4
• Plugpack included
• Dimensions: 202(W) x 150(H) x 20(D)mm
Display your digital photos or videos
with an MP3 file for background music if
you like. The files can be loaded via a
compatible memory card or via a USB
cable (available separately). You can
control the display for individual images,
a slide show or thumbnails with the
remote or with the
$
built-in keys.
Was $274 Limited Stock
Cat: QM-3768
119
Cat: AR-1868
Limited Stock
Record and encode stereo audio MP3 straight to your
iPod® - no computer required! Simply connect an audio
source to the dock and record via the voice/memo
recording mode. You can adjust the
$
recording level and also sync to your
PC via the USB port.
Component/Composite
Video to VGA Converter
119
Cat: AA-0498
• Suits iPod® Classic, Touch, Nano 3G and 4G
• Mains plugpack included
• Dimensions: 100(L) x 100(W) x 35(H)mm
Infrared Digital Pen and Notetaker
$19
USB Digital
TV Tuner
Watch high definition digital TV
on your desktop or laptop. Simple to set up
and use, just connect the USB stick, plug in
the antenna, install the software and away
you go.
Perfect for
Students or
Meeting
Notetakers!
160
Cat: XC-0355
$
79 95
Cat: XC-4886
USB RJ45 Extension Adaptor
Connect any USB device to your computer from up to 50 metres away via
a standard Cat 5 network cable. Now you can have your printer, webcam,
keyboard, mouse or any other USB device exactly where you
want it without having to move your computer around.
• PC and Mac compatible
• Requires standard Cat 5e cables
• Supports USB 1.1
• Transmitter and Receiver included
$
$
This compact converter box accepts a range of video input
signals and converts them to VGA specification for use on CRT,
LCD, etc. Also accepts YPbPr input for DVD
players, Xbox®, Wii®, or other video
sources up to 1080i. Simple on-screen
set up. No software required.
109
Cat: XC-4873
• Includes remote control
• 145mm wide
• For full specs see website
Note: iPod® not included
Just clip to any A4 sheet of paper, start writing or drawing and
everything you enter will be captured electronically. Two
modes of operation: Mobile mode allows you to take and store
notes (up to 100 A4 pages) while away from your computer in
meetings, lectures or conferences; or Online mode, where you use
it like a tablet PC connected to your computers USB port. Simple
and intuitive to use: like putting pen to paper.
Software included.
$25
249
Dock Recorder for iPod®
$
Was $99
Limited Stock
10" Electronic
Photo Frame
• USB port • 3.5mm input jack for audio auxiliary input
• Gooseneck: 200mm long
• Size: 140(H) x 75(W)mm
$
89
Cat: QM-3777
Was $59.95
7" Digital
Photo Frame
Cat: XC-4867
Hands-Free Bluetooth
FM Transmitter
• Rechargeable battery on receiver unit
• Battery status indicator
• Standard off-the-shelf ink refills
Was $179
49 95
$10
• Supports USB 1.1 & 2.0 Plug-and-Play
• Stereo audio input via RCA connectors
• Dimensions: 35(W) x 95(D) x 15(H)mm
Note: iPod® not included
$
69 95
Cat: XC-4884
• Supports free-to-air DTV in many countries
• Software with time shifting
and scheduled recording
• Compatible with Windows XP,
MCE and Vista
• Antenna, cable and software included
• Supports Electronic Program Guide (EPG),
subtitle and Teletext
See website for full systems requirements.
Free Call: 1800 022 888 for orders! www.jaycar.com.au
Hollywood
Camera Style
USB Webcam
Broadcast yourself all over the net on
your USB movie camera webcam. A
strong gooseneck for getting that closeup shot.
• 350mm long
• Image Sensor:
300k pixels
• Resolution:
640 x 480
Was $35.95
Limited Stock
$
24 95
Cat: QC-3227
*Note:
Laptop not
included
$11
5
Power Supplies
Low Frequency Inverter Sinewave - 1200W Sine Wave Inverters
Suited to commercial applications, this sine wave low frequency inverter uses low frequency
switching with large toroid output transformers to give ultra-robust performance and surge ratings
much higher than conventional switchmode inverters. This results in lower standby power, lower
heating & less wasted energy from the batteries. Being a pure sine wave, you can connect any
device or appliance to the output-even delicate electronics and equipment with variable speed
motors. It also features a Green Power function - this is automatic load sensing which allows the
inverter to remain in standby mode until an AC load is turned on. This conserves battery power as
the inverter uses only about 10% of normal power when in standby mode. The
amount of standby power required to start the inverter is user-adjustable.
1299
$
• Microprocessor controlled
• 3m wired remote control
Cat: MI-5180
• Soft Start • Fan cooled
• Automatic voltage regulation
• Reverse polarity & Overload protection
• Input low/high voltage protection
• Low battery alarm
• Dimensions (L x W x H) 465 x 280 x 120mm
180 Watt 380 Watt 600 Watt 1000 Watt 1500 Watt 2000 Watt -
Cat
Cat
Cat
Cat
Cat
Cat
MI-5160 $219
MI-5162 $269
MI-5164 $399
MI-5170 $799
MI-5172 $1099
MI-5174 $1349
3-Stage 6/12V
Automatic Battery Charger
Automatically diagnoses, recovers and recharges 6 or 12 volt leadacid, gel, and AGM rechargeable batteries for boats,
motorcycles etc. Maintains your battery for months
and extends battery life by constantly monitoring
battery condition and bulk, trickle or
maintenance charges accordingly.
Remote Controlled
240V Mains Outlets
Switch any mains appliance rated up to 10A on or
off remotely. Supplied with three receivers and a
remote control, you can control up to three
separate devices and switch them individually.
$
• Output voltage: 7.2, 14.4VDC
• Capacity: 1.2 - 20Ah
• Dimensions: 110(L) x 62(W) x 45(H)mm
39
$
95
• Range: 30m
• Frequency: 433.92MHz
Cat: MS-6140
• Max Power: 2500W (10A)
• Remote size: 100(L) x 35(W) x 20(H)mm
49 95
Cat: MB-3603
Long Life Pre-Charged
Rechargeable Batteries
These fantastic batteries feature ultra-low self-discharge
technology and have an 85% charge retention after 1 year.
They are supplied in a charged state and can be used
immediately after purchase. A handy storage case is
included. AAA, AA & Sub C styles are available.
SB-1752
7.2V NI-MH RC BATTERIES
High capacity, high current discharge Ni-MH packs for radio
control cars. Fitted with standard "Tamiya" type plug.
7.2V Ni-MH 2,000mAh
Cat. SB-2312 $34.95
800mAh AAA
2,000mAh AA
2,000mAh AA with solder tags 1.2V
3,000mAh Sub C with solder tags 1.2V
7.2V Ni-MH 3,300mAh
Cat SB-2314 $49.95
SB-1752
SB-1750
SB-1751
SB-1759
$17.95
$21.95
$7.95
$9.95
SB-1750
Sight & Sound
USB Guitar &
Microphone Audio
Interface
USB Microphone
with Stand
Excellent quality reproduction on vocals,
acoustic instruments or podcasting.
• USB powered - no phantom power needed
• Built-in volume control
$
95
• Stand with shock mount
• Plug and play - no drivers needed
Cat: AM-4102
See website for full specifications
99
Ideal for DIY PA bins or
replacement drivers. With
aluminium frames, high
efficiency and power handling
capacity, these drivers offer
exceptional value.
• Size: 100(L) x 28(Dia)mm
10" PA Driver Cat. CG-2381
Mix, play and scratch your own MP3 tracks directly from your PC. The i-Mix gives you the control
you lose when going from a traditional mixer to a laptop. It sends MIDI data from the
controller to your DJ software without the inconvenience of mouse control.
Complete with LE versions of Deckadance & Traktor 3
$
software. This is the ultimate tool for the performing DJ.
Features:
Cat: AM-4250
• 2-deck controller • Mix 2 files in 1 controller
• USB powered, no extra power needed
System requirements:
• Totally portable, smaller and lighter than a laptop • Windows XP, SP2 or Vista
• 2 pro jog wheels • Pitch, search and scratch
• Pentium III or Athlon 1GHz
• 3 faders: 1 cross fade, 1 volume per deck
• 512MB RAM
• 6 EQ filters with 6 kills
• Dimensions: 360(W) x 202(H) x 45(D)mm
399
GUITAR PRACTICE AMPS
Practice amps with enough volume for the odd garage jam. They have a headphone
jack so you can play until your fingers bleed without upsetting the neighbours.
69
95
Cat: CS-2554
Paper Cone
PA Drivers
Simple, passive single
unbalanced input audio
interface for home recording or
webcasting. It works on PC or Mac, requires no drivers or
setup and is powered by the USB port.
$
I-Mix Club USB DJ MIDI Controller
• 6" speaker • Headphone jack
$
• CD input • Switchable distortion
• Mains powered
• Dimensions; 250(W) x 315(H) x 205(D)mm
Our pure sine wave inverters are able to provide
bundles of power in mobile and permanent
installations. In addition to the normal 240VAC outlet,
all models also have a USB port for powering all your
gadgets. This range of sine wave inverters is suitable for any
application where you want to run sensitive equipment and the larger units can be
used in permanent installations such as caravan, 4WD, camper or even marine.
119
Cat: AM-2037
$
Power handling: 150WRMS
12" PA Driver Cat. CG-2383
Power handling: 200WRMS
99
Cat: CG-2381
$
119
Cat: CG-2383
Speaker Cover
Suit or models CS-2514, 16, 17 &18
Protect your speaker investment from the
elements while being transported or
from bumps and scrapes when in
storage. UV and water resistant.
Suits PA Speaker and
Speaker/Amp CS-2514
or CS-2517
CS-2500 $24.95
Suits 12" Foldback
Speaker CS-2516
CS-2501 $24.95
Suits 12" Subwoofer CS-2518
CS-2502 $24.95
50W Guitar Amplifier also available Cat. CS-2556 $199
6
All savings are based on original recommended retail prices.
IT & Comms
Mini Roll-Up
Wireless Keyboard
15 - 24V Laptop
Power Supply
Life for business travellers and students just got a
lot easier. Now you can have a convenient roll-up
keyboard to take on the road or to lectures, and it’s
wireless. Convenient size with splash resistant keypad so is
ideal for harsh environments or areas that have to be
constantly cleaned such as sawmills,
factories, workshops and
food preparation areas.
Adaptors to fit the major manufacturers' DC
power input sockets, and
enough grunt to suit all but the
most power demanding laptop
models. It also displays the
output voltage and
automatically adjusts output
voltage according to which
connector is fitted. 10 different
connectors to suit a variety of
different laptops. Check our website for compatibility.
• Maximum power output: 90W
• Voltage range: 15 - 24V
• Current: 6A (max)
• 138(L) x 58(W) x 37(H)mm
$
• Standard
QWERTY layout
• Washable
and hygienic
• Supports Windows
• Size: 370(L) x 123(W) x 15(H)mm
69 95
Cat: MP-3476
USB Optical Mouse
with Number Keypad
• Measures: 67(W) x 110(L) x 20(H)mm
69 95
Cat: XC-5145
IP68 Rated USB
Optical Mouse
Notebook computers are great when you are moving
about or space is at a premium. However, the lack of a
proper numeric keypad and mouse can
be a real nuisance. This problem is
easily fixed with this new
combination mouse with built-in
keypad. It simply plugs into
the notebook computer's
USB port and gives you a
full function numeric keypad
and mouse. Lead length 700mm.
$
$
Impervious to anything you can throw at it, having the
highest rating for dust and water resistance. It performs all
the normal mouse functions including scrolling and has a
tactile rubber shell. Ideal for environments such as labs,
factories, marine, military,
science, food preparation
etc. It can be cleaned with
$
95
water, alcohol, or
disinfectant.
Cat: XM-5139
39
• USB powered
• IP68 rated
37 95
High performance 4-port hub with a difference:
it has one port on top, so it's much easier to
place a memory stick into.
Data transfer of up to 480Mbps.
• Plug and Play, no drivers
needed, hot swappable
• Compatible with Windows 98,
2000, Me, XP, Vista and Mac
• Self-powered
• Dimensions: 80(W) x 90(D) x 18(H)mm
$
Note: Flash drive not included
7 port high speed hub also available
(2 ports on the top) - simple, flexible and highly
scalable connectivity solution. XC-4883 $59.95
Mini USB SD Card Reader
29 95
Cat: XC-4804
USB Wireless
Rechargeable Optical
Mouse
With an ergonomic design
to perfectly fit into your
hand, an optical lens for
precision aiming, and a
rubber-like finish which
prevents it slipping in your
hand, this mouse stands out as a
very modern piece of equipment.
Relax and enjoy its features.
• USB interface - Plug and Play
• Compatible with Win 95/98/2000/NT/ME/XP
Cat: XM-5138
$
34 95
Cat: XM-5132
On-Line 1000VA 700W UPS
SD cards are the most popular storage devices
for digital cameras and just about every other
device that uses portable storage. This low cost
card reader has a SD slot on the side and is
compact enough to take anywhere
• USB 2.0 • Compact size • No drivers required
$
8 95
Cat: XC-4756
2.5/3.5" SATA HDD Dock
with Card Reader
A SATA Docking station loaded with features. Dock your 2.5 or 3.5 inch SATA
HDD and it will instantly mount on your computer as an external hard drive. It
also features slots for a multitude of cards. CF/SD/MS and their variations can
all be read. It also has 2 USB ports. An invaluable tool for cloning disks or
debugging HDD problems. Note: HD drive not included
$
•Up to 480Mbps transfer rate with USB 2.0
•Up to 3Gb/s transfer rate with eSATA
4 Port High
Performance USB Hub
79
95
Cat: XC-4692
This Industrial quality true online UPS is designed for critical
loads. The UPS provides a perfectly clean sine wave
output no matter what the mains throws at it.
You’re covered for surges, spikes, noise,
brownouts and blackouts for as long as the
batteries last. A backlit LCD shows you the
operating status and advises you of any fault
condition. It also provides an RS-232
interface so the UPS can be connected to a
computer and used with the included
management software. See Website
for full specifications
$
749
• Pure sine wave output
Cat: MP-5210
• True on-line operation
• 2 x 240V outlets • Software included
DIY Kits
240V 10A Deluxe Motor
Speed Controller Kit
School Zone
Speed Alert Kit
This deluxe kit provides full speed control from near zero to
maximum RPM, good speed regulation under load, very smooth
low speed operation and is rated for devices up to 2300W. It also
has soft-start to eliminate the kick from larger power
tools and has interference suppression filtering, fuse
protection and over-current protection with limiting.
Basically a specialised timer that alerts you with a flashing LED
when school zone-reduced speeds are in force. The unit will flash
for the whole time the restrictions operate in the morning and
afternoon. The kit includes all specified components, double-sided
PCB and case with machined and screen-printed lid.
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine April 2009
$
• Overlay PCB & all components
• Machined case included
99 95
Cat: KC-5478
Headlight Reminder For Cars
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine August 2001
Nothing is more frustrating than getting into your car early in
the morning, only to discover that you had left your headlights
on the night before, running your car’s battery flat. Features
include a modulated alarm, ignition and lights monitoring,
optional door switch detection, time-out alarm and a short
delay before the alarm sounds. Build and install
this hassle-saving kit and enjoy a feature in
$
95
your car that many luxury vehicle owners
have long taken for granted.
Cat: KC-5317
27
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine April 2009
$
49 95
Cat: KC-5472
Battery Zapper MkIII
Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine July 2009
The popular battery zapper kit has gone through a
couple of upgrades and this is the latest easier-tobuild version. Like the original project from 2005, it
attacks a common cause of failure in lead acid*
batteries: sulphation, which can send a battery to an early grave. The
circuit produces short bursts of high levels of energy to reverse the
sulphation effect. The battery condition checker is no longer included
and the circuit has been updated and revamped to provide more
reliable, long-term operation. It still includes test points for a DMM
and binding posts for a battery charger.
* Not recommended for use with gel batteries.
• PCB with solder mask, overlay and components
• Screen printed machined case • 6, 12 & 24VDC
Free Call: 1800 022 888 for orders! www.jaycar.com.au
$
79 95
Cat: KC-5479
7
S e c u r i t y & S u rv e i l l a n c e
4 Zone Security Alarm System
with 2 Wire Technology
Rapport CCTV Field Tester
Supplied with
• Main control unit
• Two PIRs
• Four door or window contact switches
• External swtich
• 240VAC Adaptor
• 50m two-core flat wire clips
• Screw/wall plugs
• Main unit: 160(H) x180(W) x35(D)mm
• Extra PIR to suit LA-5476 $29.95
• Rechargeable Li-Po battery
• CCTV video monitor
• Video signal generator
• Digital multimeter
This alarm is so simple DIY enthusiasts will love it! All system components (sensors, sirens)
are connected to the control unit via a two core flat wire. The unit has a built- in
keypad with status LED and three
modes of operation (Home, Out,
Off). All sensors and sounders are
line protected so any attempt to
interfere will sound the alarm.
$
149
Cat: LA-5475
Hands Free Colour Video Door Phone
Who’s at the door? With this video door phone you can view and talk to guests before
letting them in or sound an alarm to turn away
unwanted visitors. The camera can also be
used at night thanks to its CCD sensor and
infrared illumination.
You can even hook up
one additional monitor
and camera to make a
comprehensive
front & back
door personal
surveillance system.
$
• 7" TFT screen • AV output
• AV input • Mains powered
• Remote door release output
449
$
• MPEG-4 compression
• 250GB HDD included
649
999
Cat: QM-3823
Multimeter specifications:
• Dimensions: 88(W) 125(H) x 40(D)mm
Mini Dome Dummy Camera
This dummy dome camera looks exactly like the real thing at a
fraction of the price. Make your business/home/office look like
it's under surveillance. It even includes a metal camera casing
inside, although it has no lens..
$
• Dimensions: 88mm(dia) x 68mm(H)mm
12 95
Cat: LA-5317
4 Channel DVR Camera Surveillance Kit
This is an excellent DVR that is ideally suited to smaller surveillance installations around the
home or office. It uses MJPEG video compression and can store over 150 hours of video on
its 250GB hard drive. Recording setup is simple and various trigger modes can be set
across the day including include timer recording, motion detection, and manual operation.
YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE
6788
4699
2822
9669
3899
4130
7155
3433
4799
6221
3100
3799
8337
3121
1614
7033
Tweed Heads
Wollongong
VICTORIA
Cheltenham
Coburg
Frankston
Geelong
Hallam
Melbourne
Ringwood
Springvale
Sunshine
Thomastown
QUEENSLAND
Aspley
Caboolture
Cairns
Ipswich
Mackay
• DVR with 250GB HDD, 4 camera inputs, USB port, and 1 x composite video output
• 4 x weather resistant COLOUR day/night cameras
• Plug-in interconnection cables
$
• Wireless remote control
• Mains adaptor
• User manual
Cat: QV-3063
649
• See website for full specification.
Cat: QV-3079
Australia Freecall Orders: Ph 1800 022 888
8
$
The system comes complete with:
A combined multiplexer and digital video recorder with Ethernet port that allows control via a
web browser. Features MPEG-4 compression, advanced motion recording, video loss
detection, remote network record and back-up support. Supplied with a 250GB HD and can
be expanded up to 400GB. See website for specifications. 340mm wide.
6021
9699
9709
9678
9369
9905
4620
4365
9439
9476
9821
4965
4721
8832
9267
9531
Specifications:
• Input voltage: 12VDC
• Charging time: 6 hours
Cat: QC-3615
Economy 4 Channel Multiplexing DVR
NEW SOUTH WALES
Albury
Ph (02)
Alexandria
Ph (02)
Bankstown
Ph (02)
Blacktown
Ph (02)
Bondi Junction Ph (02)
Brookvale
Ph (02)
Campbelltown Ph (02)
Erina
Ph (02)
Gore Hill
Ph (02)
Hornsby
Ph (02)
Liverpool
Ph (02)
Newcastle
Ph (02)
Penrith
Ph (02)
Rydalmere
Ph (02)
Sydney City
Ph (02)
Taren Point
Ph (02)
Designed with portability and the
professional CCTV
engineer in mind, this is an
advanced piece of test
equipment with a variety of
functions. As well as
performing multimeter
functions, it will test the
quality of a video image
signal and display it on the
3.5" LCD.
Ph (07) 5524 6566
Ph (02) 4226 7089
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
(03)
9585
9384
9781
5221
9796
9663
9870
9547
9310
9465
5011
1811
4100
5800
4577
2030
9053
1022
8066
3333
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
Ph
(07)
(07)
(07)
(07)
(07)
3863
5432
4041
3282
4953
0099
3152
6747
5800
0611
Maroochydore Ph (07) 5479 3511
Mermaid Beach Ph (07) 5526 6722
Townsville
Ph (07) 4772 5022
Underwood
Ph (07) 3841 4888
Woolloongabba Ph (07) 3393 0777
AUSTRALIAN CAPITAL TERRITORY
Belconnen
Ph (02) 6253 5700
Fyshwick
Ph (02) 6239 1801
TASMANIA
Hobart
Ph (03) 6272 9955
Launceston
Ph (03) 6334 2777
SOUTH AUSTRALIA
Adelaide
Ph (08) 8231 7355
Clovelly Park Ph (08) 8276 6901
Gepps Cross
Ph (08) 8262 3200
WESTERN AUSTRALIA
Maddington
Ph (08) 9493 4300
Midland
Ph (08) 9250 8200
Northbridge
Ph (08) 9328 8252
Rockingham
Ph (08) 9592 8000
NORTHERN TERRITORY
Darwin
Ph (08) 8948 4043
NEW ZEALAND
Christchurch Ph (03) 379 1662
Dunedin
Ph (03) 471 7934
Glenfield
Ph (09) 444 4628
Hamilton
Ph (07) 846 0177
Hastings
Ph (06) 876 0239
Manukau
Ph (09) 263 6241
Newmarket
Ph (09) 377 6421
Palmerston Nth Ph (06) 353 8246
Wellington
Ph (04) 801 9005
Freecall Orders Ph 0800 452 922
Prices valid to 23rd July ‘09
Free Call: 1800 022 888 for orders! www.jaycar.com.au
PRODUCT SHOWCASE
Waterproof ABS case from Jaycar
You could buy a cheaper case for your compact camera, test
gear, medical equipment, etc, at the local bargain store – but
would you? It certainly won’t offer your gear much in the
way of protection, especially if it gets wet.
This new 260 x 94 x 159mm (external) case from Jaycar is
made from tough ABS and is ideal for transporting sensitive
equipment. It will protect valuable items from transit damage, dust and water ingress. The clam-shell style box has
a soft “pluck” foam insert with precut squares that
can be removed to snugly fit the item you want to
protect. Its lid is also lined with egg shell foam, and
is secured with strong ‘snap closed’ fasteners with
a gasket seal that is waterproof and dustproof when
closed. The case has a carry handle and two moulded
anchor points that can be used for attaching tamper seals or padlocks. It
will also float in case you’re unfortunate enough to drop your gear in the drink.
It also comes in any colour you want, as long as it’s black. Ideal for cameras, test and
measurement equipment, medical equipment etc, the usable internal dimensions Contact:
Jaycar Electronics (all stores)
are 239 x 94 x 159mm (w x h x d).
You will be hard pressed to find a better PO Box 107, Rydalmere NSW 2116
case, even at twice the price – which, inci- Order Tel: 1800 022 888 Fax: (02) 8832 3188
Website: www.jaycar.com.au
dentally is $49.95 (rrp).
Cutter’s IP modem replaces analog and ISDN modems
The SSV IGW/920-IPM from Cutter Electronics offers the
ability to replace conventional modems with an IP-based intranet
or Internet connection. The 10/100 Mbps LAN interface of the
IGW/920-IPM is used for the connection to the IP network.
The serial RS232 interface of the IGW/920-IPM emulates an AT
command interpreter. The IP address of the other IP modem in
each case serves as the phone number for the connection setup.
Alternatively, a DNS name or phonebook entry
(quick dialing via match table) can be used. Contact:
The IGW/920-IPM is easy to set up using Cutter Electronics Pty Ltd
the integrated browser interface. For this an Unit 12, 137-145 Rooks Rd, Vermont, Vic 3131
Ethernet LANbased connection to a PC with Tel: (03) 9873 5088 Fax: (03) 9873 5099
web browser will be established.
Website: www.cutter.com.au
Another PA labour-saver from Altronics
Here’s one to bring a gleam to the eye of anyone who’s had
to install a lot of PA or fire warning ceiling speakers: Altronic
Distributors new Redback One-Shot, a ceiling-mounted speaker
complete with its own mounting kit and grille.
Instead of the usual four fixing screws, four
cap covers and a lot of labour, this requires
no fixings, fits in around four seconds and
looks superb.
Simply cut the hole in the 10-13mm
thick ceiling (Altronics have the right size
holesaw!), connect the speaker wires to the
integral terminal block then push in the
Contact:
spring-loaded catches. The job is done!
The model shown is a C-2146C 100V Altronic Distributors Pty Ltd
5W PA speaker which retails for $31.10 inc PO Box 8350, Perth Busn Centre, WA 6849
GST; 8 15W and Fire Evac models are also Tel: 1300 780 999 Fax: 1300 790 999
Website: www.altronics.com.au
available.
siliconchip.com.au
Farnell’s new online
technical training service
In recognition of the increasing complexity of electronic solutions, Farnell
has launched TechCast, a new online
technical training service.
It provides assistance and answers
to customers seeking to understand the
latest technology and obtain guidance
in the selection of the most appropriate
components for their designs.
Techcast modules provide detailed
information about a wide and diverse
range of electronics technologies in a
single, easy-to-use location.
Accessed by a single click from the
Farnell website homepage, TechCast
online training modules are adopted
from suppliers and placed in standard
format to ease familiarity.
Constantly added to, the library currently contains over 100 modules from
31 suppliers, such as Cree, Freescale,
Molex and Murata Power Solutions,
providing information on devices and
products ranging from FPGAs and
Microprocessors, to LEDs, connectors
and front-end power supplies.
An alphabetical search feature helps
to speed up locating the required training module and users can select either
narrated or silent formats.
Adjacent to each training module
indexed in the library is a ‘Parts List’
button which provides direct access
to full technical and purchasing details
for products referred to, or relevant to,
that specific TechCast module.
With a single click customers can
then purchase products for same-day
despatch across Australia and New
Zealand with no minimum order sizes.
TechCast complements other service initiatives recently introduced by
Farnell, aimed at providing industryleading support to design engineers
across the globe.
These include the i-Buy free eprocurement management system and Live
SC
Technical Chat.
Contact:
Farnell
72 Ferndell St, Chester Hill NSW 2162
Tel: 1300 361 005 Fax: 1300 361 225
Website: www.farnell.com.au
July 2009 57
Multi-Function Active
Filter Module
Versatile design can
be configured as a
low-pass, high-pass
or bandpass filter
just by moving a few
jumper links
By JOHN CLARKE
This versatile Active Filter is ideal for use as an active
crossover in loudspeaker systems but has lots of other uses
as well. It can be configured as a low-pass filter (for driving
sub-woofer amplifiers), as a high-pass filter or as a bandpass
filter, simply by moving a few on-board jumper links.
A
CTIVE FILTERS ARE used in
many analog circuits to tailor the
frequency response. For example, an
active filter could be used to prevent
signals below 20Hz from passing
through to the next stage (eg, to an
amplifier). In this case, the filter allows the higher audio frequencies to
pass through but blocks the sub-audio
signals (including DC).
This type of filter is called a “highpass” (HP) filter. If a HP filter is incorporated into an audio amplifier, it will
prevent the woofer in a loudspeaker
system from being driven at very low
frequencies. In fact, it could be used
as a turntable rumble filter to follow a
58 Silicon Chip
magnetic cartridge preamplifier.
Preventing a loudspeaker from being driven at very low frequencies
is important because such frequencies would cause audible distortion
in the sound due to excessive cone
movement. In addition, excessive
cone movement at or below the loudspeaker’s resonance frequency could
damage the loudspeaker.
Similarly, an active filter could also
be used to limit signals above 20kHz.
This will prevent supersonic signals
from driving the loudspeaker and
protect the tweeter(s) from damage.
This type of filter is called a low-pass
(LP) filter; it allows frequencies below
a certain frequency to pass through but
blocks higher frequencies.
Bandpass filter
Cascading a high-pass filter and a
low-pass filter produces a bandpass
filter. So if a 20Hz high-pass filter and
a 20kHz low-pass filter are cascaded,
we end up with a bandpass ranging
from 20Hz to 20kHz. This means that
the signal is attenuated both below
20Hz and above 20kHz, while those
frequencies between 20Hz and 20kHz
are basically left un-attenuated.
However, some attenuation (or re
duction) in level does occur as the
signal frequency approaches 20Hz
siliconchip.com.au
PASSIVE FILTERS
ACTIVE FILTERS
TWEETER
HP
PREAMPLIFIER
SIGNAL
MIDRANGE
BP
TWEETER
HP
(HIGH PASS)
AMPLIFIER
AMPLIFIER
AMPLIFIER
SIGNAL
MIDRANGE
BP
(BAND PASS)
AMPLIFIER
WOOFER
LP
(USUALLY IN LOUDSPEAKER ENCLOSURE)
Fig.1: a single power amplifier is usually used to drive
a passive crossover network in a loudspeaker box.
and 20kHz, ie, the so-called corner or
“roll-off” frequencies.
Additional filters can also be used to
split the 20Hz-20kHz audio frequency
range into separate frequency ranges or
bands. This might be done to produce
a 2-way or 3-way active crossover for
two or three drivers in a loudspeaker
system.
In greater detail, many loudspeaker
systems include woofer, mid-range
and tweeter drivers in the same box
– see Fig.1. This is called a 3-way
system, while a 2-way system includes
just a woofer and a tweeter.
The separate drivers are used because no single driver can faithfully
reproduce the whole audible range
from 20Hz to 20kHz. So the audio band
of frequencies is divided up and each
driver is fed with its own “ideal” range
of frequencies. In a 3-way system, for
example, the woofer could be provided
with signals ranging from 20Hz to say
150Hz, while the midrange would
handle signals ranging from 150Hz to
2kHz. The tweeter would then cover
the remainder of the audio range, ie,
from 2-20kHz.
Passive crossovers
In most loudspeaker systems, the
incoming audio signal is divided into
separate frequency bands using passive filters. These “crossover filters”
are located inside the loudspeaker box
itself and are made up using inductors,
capacitors and resistors.
Basically, a well-designed crossover
network gives outputs to match the
particular drivers used. This ensures
that each driver (ie, woofer, mid-range
and tweeter) is fed only with a frequency band it can effectively reproduce.
siliconchip.com.au
WOOFER
LP
(LOW PASS)
Fig.2: the arrangement for an active crossover filter system.
The filters go before the power amplifiers and a separate
amplifier is required for each loudspeaker driver.
In addition, the design must cater for
drivers that have different sensitivities
and set the signal levels to achieve an
overall flat frequency response.
For example, the woofer is often
less sensitive than the midrange driver
and tweeter and so the signals to the
latter drivers must be reduced so that
the output levels from the three drivers are well matched. This does waste
amplifier power, however.
Another problem to contend with
is non-linearity in the driver impedances and so extra components are
often used in the crossover network to
correct this, so that the filter appears
to drive a purely resistive load. As a
result, the crossover networks in highperformance speaker systems are often
complex and can be difficult to design
and optimise.
They also interpose a complex RLC
network between the amplifier and
the speakers which can mean a loss
of damping factor. That particularly
affects the lower frequencies where a
high damping factor is most needed to
achieve tight, clean bass and midrange
reproduction.
As shown in Fig.1, a single power
amplifier usually drives the passive
crossover network in a loudspeaker
system. However, some loudspeaker
systems provide additional connections so that each driver can either
be driven independently by its own
amplifier (via its passive filter) or by
a single amplifier but with separate
wiring to each passive filter section.
Active crossovers
Active crossovers are an alternative
to passive filtering. However, for this to
work, a separate amplifier is required
for each driver – see Fig.2. For a stereo
system, that means six power amplifiers (or three stereo amplifiers) to drive
3-way loudspeakers or four amplifiers
for 2-way loudspeakers.
As shown in Fig.2, the crossover
filtering is now placed ahead of each
amplifier to set the frequency band
Specifications
Voltage Gain: adjustable from 0-2; typically set at 1
Frequency Response: filter dependent
Filter Attenuation slope: 24dB/octave or 80dB/decade
Total Harmonic Distortion: typically .003% at 1V RMS
Signal-to-Noise Ratio: >100dB with respect to 1V input and 22Hz to
22kHz unweighted
Input Impedance: 47kΩ
Supply Voltage: ±15V to ± 60V DC dual rail supply or +12-30V DC single
rail supply or 11-43VAC
Current Consumption: 40mA maximum
July 2009 59
FILTERS
SELECTION
MATRIX
INPUT
BUFFER
INPUT
HPin
HP
IC2b
LPout
IN
x1
HP
IC2a
LEVEL
OUT
HPout
IC1a
OUTPUT
AMPLIFIER
x2
LPin
FILTERS
LP
IC3a
VR1
OUTPUT
IC1b
LP
IC3b
Fig.3: block diagram of the Multi-Function Active Filter. The low-pass and
high-pass filter stages each consist of two cascaded op amps and the unit is
configured by installing jumper links on the pins of the “selection matrix”.
applied to its driver. There are two
advantages to this scheme: (1) better
control of the driver and (2) the inductive load presented by the driver does
not affect the filter response (as it does
in a passive system).
So our Multi-Function Active Filter
module is designed to be used ahead
of each amplifier. Basically, you need
to build and configure one module for
each driver (and amplifier) in the system. For a woofer, the module would
be configured as a low-pass (LP) filter,
while a bandpass (BP) filter would be
used ahead of the mid-range amplifier.
The tweeter driver amplifier would
have a high-pass (HP) filter ahead of it.
Supply options
In operation, the Multi-Function Active Filter would typically be powered
from the supply rails of the amplifier.
Options are available to power the
module from supply rails ranging from
±60V down to ±15V or from an 11-43V
AC source.
AMPLITUDE
CUTOFF
ROLLOFF
SLOPE
TRANSITION
BAND
A HIGH PASS (HP)
Block diagram
Fig.3 shows the block diagram of the
Multi-Function Active Filter (minus
the power supply). It uses an input
buffer stage (IC1a), four op amps to
form the filter stages (IC2a,b & IC3a,b)
and an output amplifier stage (IC1b)
IC1a is configured with a gain of
one and can be connected to drive
either the HP or LP filter stages, depending on the jumper options on the
PASS
BAND
FREQUENCY
Rolloff slope
Note that the signal is not fully
attenuated at the cutoff points but
instead gradually decreases at a rate
determined by the rolloff slope. In
this case, each 2-pole filter stage has
a rolloff of 40dB per decade or 12dB
per octave. However, because the
filter stages are cascaded, this rolloff
increases to 80dB per decade or 24dB
per octave and the signal level is actually 6dB down at the cutoff (crossover)
points.
For a high-pass filter, the output
from IC2b is fed through to level con-
HIGH PASS
CUTOFF
CUTOFF
PASS
BAND
STOP
BAND
The Multi-Function Active Filter
can also be powered from a single
supply rail, such as +25V, +15V or
+12V. The 12V option enables it to be
used in cars.
On-board jumper links are used to
configure the module for LP, BP or
HP operation. The roll-off frequencies
are set by selecting the appropriate
resistor and capacitor values in the
filter feedback networks. These filter
component calculations are made easy
by using freely available software from
the Internet.
“Selection Matrix” block. If we want
a HP filter, then terminal “IN” is connected to “HPin” on the matrix block.
Alternatively, for an LP filter, “IN” is
connected to terminal “LPin”.
As shown, the high-pass filter uses
two 2-pole HP filters based on IC2a &
IC2b. These are connected in series (or
“cascaded”). Similarly, the low-pass
filter stage consists of 2-pole LP filters
IC3a & IC3b.
Fig.4a shows the response for a HP
filter and the way the filter response
is described. As indicated, the region
where frequencies pass through unattenuated is called the passband. Below
the cutoff frequency, the response
begins to rolloff (or is reduced) in
level. This rolloff region is called the
stopband.
An LP filter is similar except that it
allows low-frequency signals to pass
through and blocks signals above the
cutoff point (Fig.4b). Finally, the bandpass filter rolls off both the low and
high-frequency signals and the pass
band is between the high-pass and
low-pass cutoff frequencies (Fig.4c).
ROLLOFF
SLOPE
ROLLOFF
SLOPE
LOW PASS
CUTOFF
PASS
BAND
ROLLOFF
SLOPE
STOP
BAND
TRANSITION
BAND
B LOW PASS (LP)
C BAND PASS (BP)
Fig.4: the high-pass filter (A), low-pass filter (B) and bandpass filter (C) response characteristics. Because the op amp
filter stages are cascaded, the rolloff slope in each case is 24dB per octave and the signal is actually 6dB down at the
cutoff (crossover) points.
60 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Parts List
Amplifiers For Active
Crossover Systems
T
HE AUDIO AMPLIFIER
requirements for active
crossover loudspeaker
systems depend on the
power hand
ling rating
for each loudspeaker. Typically, a
woofer (or subwoofer) amplifier should have
twice the power of
the midrange and treble
amplifiers. For example, a 100W
power amplifier could be used for the
woofer, and 50W amplifiers used for the midrange and treble drivers.
One problem is that the output from a preamplifier will only have a single
RCA output for each left and right channel. However, you will need to connect the preamp signal to two or three active filters, depending on how many
drivers are in the loudspeaker.
This problem is easily overcome by using an RCA Plug to 2 x RCA Socket
such as the Jaycar Cat. PA-3560. Two such adaptors will be required for each
channel if you want to drive three active filter modules (ie, if you have a 3-way
loudspeaker system).
Alternatively, you could use RCA plug-to-plug leads with piggyback RCA
sockets (eg, Jaycar WA-7090/1/2/3 or Altronics P-7260) or you could make
up your own 2-way or 3-way RCA socket panels.
trol VR1 by connecting point “HPout”
to “OUT” in the selection matrix.
Alternatively, for a low-pass filter, the
output of IC3b at “LPout” is connected
to the “OUT” terminal.
Bandpass filter connections
Bandpass filtering is achieved by
cascading the high-pass and low-pass
filter stages, ie, by connecting the
output of the high-pass stages to the
input of the low-pass stages or vice
versa. However, it is normal to feed
the signal to a HP filter first and then
use this to drive the LP filter, rather
than placing the LP filter first. This
will result in less noise due to the final
low-pass filtering.
However, you can connect the LP filters first if that’s what you want to do.
Normally, to configure a bandpass
filter, the signal is first fed to HP filter
stage IC2a by linking “IN” to “HPin”.
The output from IC2b is then fed to
the input of low-pass stage IC3a by
connecting “HPout” to “LPin” in the
Selection Matrix. The resulting bandsiliconchip.com.au
pass filtered signal at the output of
IC3b is then fed to VR1 by connecting
“LPout” to “OUT”.
Level control
The signal on VR1’s wiper is fed
to IC1b. This is configured as a noninverting amplifier with a gain of two.
As a result, VR1 can be adjusted to
vary the signal at its output between
zero and x2. This level adjustment allow the sound levels from the woofer,
midrange and tweeter drivers to be
adjusted when multiple filter modules
are used.
By the way, the recommended design for each 2-pole stage is for a Butterworth response. When connected
in series, the result of cascading two
Butterworth filters is a Linkwitz-Riley
(L-R) response.
This is ideal because at the crossover
region, where one filter takes over from
another, the overall L-R frequency response is flat. Note that the HP and LP
filters must be set for same crossover
frequency for this to happen.
1 UB3 plastic utility case 130 x
68 x 44mm (optional)
1 PC board, code 01107091,
123 x 63mm
1 3-way PC-mount screw
terminal block with 5.08mm
pin spacing (CON1)
4 DIP8 IC sockets
1 3-way DIL pin header with
2.54mm pin spacings
2 3-way SIL pin header with
2.54mm pin spacings
5 jumper plugs to suit pin
headers
1 100mm length of 0.8mm tinned
copper wire or four 0Ω links
4 PC stakes
Semiconductors
3 LM833 dual op amps (IC1-IC3)
1 TL071, LF351 single op amp
(IC4)
2 1N4744 15V 1W zener diodes
(ZD1,ZD2)
2 1N4004 1A 400V diodes
(D1,D2)
Capacitors
2 470µF 16V PC electrolytic
1 100µF 16V PC electrolytic
2 4.7µF non-polarised (NP)
electrolytic
2 100nF MKT polyester
1 10nF MKT polyester
1 220pF ceramic
C1,C2,C3 to suit application (use
MKT polyester) (see text & tables)
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 47kΩ
2 150Ω
4 10kΩ
3 10Ω
Ra, Rb, R1, R2 & R3 to suit power
supply & filter type (use 1% 0.25W
for R1, R2 & R3) (see text & tables)
As indicated previously, the MultiFunction Active Filter board can only
produce a single LP, HP or BP filter
output. This means that it can only
provide signal to one loudspeaker
driver – it is not designed to provide
for two (or more) outputs.
This in turn means that if you want
separate LP, BP and HP filter outputs,
then three Multi-Function Active Filter modules must be built (or six for a
stereo system). Basically, a different
filter is required for each amplifier
and it can be installed inside its associated amplifier’s case.
July 2009 61
Fig.5: this screen grab shows the frequency response for the low-pass filter
configuration with a nominal corner frequency of 1kHz. The attenuation slope
is 24dB per octave.
arrangement. This was used in preference to the unity gain Sallen-Key style
of filter because the MFB response
is less affected by component value
variations due to manufacturing tolerances.
Note that 10Ω stopper resistors are
included in series with the HP filter
inputs. This is done in each case to
prevent instability (oscillation) in the
preceding stage. IC2a’s output is fed
to the second HP filter stage IC2b (ie,
the stages are cascaded), while IC3a
drives the second LP filter stage IC3b.
For a HP filter, IC2b’s output is fed
to level potentiometer VR1 by linking
“HPout” to “OUT” in the Selection
Matrix. Alternatively, for a LP filter, the
output from IC3b is connected to level
potentiometer VR1 using a jumper to
link “LPout” to “OUT”. Again, this
functions exactly as described for
block diagram Fig.3.
Finally, for a bandpass arrangement,
HP filter IC2b’s output is fed to LP
filter IC3a via a jumper link between
“HPout” and “LPin”. IC3b’s output is
then fed to VR1 level via a jumper link
between “LPout” and “Out”.
Minimising noise
Fig.6: the frequency response for a high-pass filter configuration with a nominal
corner frequency of 1kHz. Once again, the attenuation slope is 24dB per octave.
The inputs of the various active filter
modules are then all driven in parallel
by the preamplifier.
Circuit details
OK, let’s now take a look at the full
circuit details – see Fig.7. It comprises
three dual op amps (IC1-IC3) plus a
single op amp (IC4) in the power supply section.
The first thing to note here is that
the designations for the op amps used
in the input buffer, filter and output
stages match those shown on the block
diagram of Fig.3. So if you’ve followed
the description for Fig.3, understanding how the full circuit works should
be a snack.
As shown, the incoming audio
signal is applied to unity gain buffer
62 Silicon Chip
stage IC1a via a 4.7µF non-polarised
capacitor and a 10Ω stopper resistor.
The capacitor is there to block any
DC voltage, while the stopper resistor
blocks any stray RF signals that may
have been picked up by the leads.
IC1a is biased to Earth 2 via the
associated 47kΩ resistor. This earth
is at 0V for plus and minus supply
rails and at half-supply (0.5Vcc) for a
single supply.
IC1a’s output is fed to either HP filter
IC2a or to LP filter IC3a, depending
on the input jumper location in the
Selection Matrix. This works exactly
as indicated previously in the description for the block diagram (Fig.3).
Both the high-pass and low-pass
filter stages (IC2a, IC2b, IC3a & IC3b)
use a multiple feedback (MFB) 2-pole
As stated earlier, the signal from
IC1a is normally fed to the HP filter
stages first (“IN” linked to “HPin”),
so that the LP filter stages can then
minimise noise. Alternatively, the LP
stages can be placed first by linking
“IN” to “LPin”, “LPout” to “HPin” and
“HPout” to “OUT”.
The resulting audio signal on VR1’s
wiper is fed directly to the non-inverting input (pin 5) of IC1b. As previously
stated, this amplifier has a gain of 2
but this gain reduces to 1 for frequencies above 72kHz due to the 220pF
capacitor across the feedback resistor.
IC1b’s output appears at pin 7 and is
coupled to the output terminals via a
150Ω isolating resistor and a 4.7µF NP
(non-polarised) capacitor and 150Ω
isolating resistor.
Power Supply
In operation, the Multi-Function Active Filter would typically be powered
from the supply rails of the amplifier.
As stated previously, options are available to power the module from dual
DC supply rails or from an AC source.
The unit can also be powered from a
single supply rail, such as +25V, +15V
or +12V. The 12V option enables it to
be used in a car.
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 63
47k
10
K
2
3
A
V–
4
IC1a
8
ZD2
15V 1W
INPUT
BUFFER
K
D2 1N4004
A
D1 1N4004
1
100nF
K
A
LK1
10
1
2
LPin
IN
R1c
HPout
OUT
SELECTION
MATRIX
HPin
LPout
470 F
16V
R3c
C2c
R2a
C1a
V–
C3a
ZD1
15V 1W
MULTI-FUNCTION ACTIVE FILTER
4.7 F
NP
Rb
Ra
3
2
3
2
R2c
A
K
R1a
LP FILTER
IC3a
C1c
HP FILTER
IC2a
C2a
470 F
16V
1
1
10k
10k
10
R1d
V–
2
C2d
R3d
R2b
C1b
100 F
16V
3
A
8
4
8
7
HP FILTER
4
IC2b
C1d
IC3b
5
6
R1b
150
C2b
6
LP FILTER
K
D1, D2
5
6
R2d
C3b
4
IC4
7
7
V–
100nF
V+
A
6
5
10k
K
ZD1, ZD2
10k
LEVEL
VR1
EARTH 1
10nF
EARTH 2
1
LK2
2
OUTPUT
AMPLIFIER
10k
220pF
IC1b
V–
V+
7
8
4.7 F
NP
1
IC1 – IC4
150
IC1 – IC3: LM833
IC4: TL071
Fig.7: the complete circuit for the Multi-Function Active Filter. IC1a serves as an input buffer stage while op amp IC1b is the output amplifier.
Cascaded op amp stages IC2a & IC2b together form the high-pass filter, while IC3a & IC3b make up the low pass filter. IC4 is used to provide a
half-supply reference if the unit is powered from a single-rail power supply.
2009
SC
INPUT
–
0V
+
SUPPLY
INPUT
4
OUTPUT
± SUPPLIES: LK1=1, LK2 =1
19070110
Rb
D2
4004
HPout
C2c C1c
1
100nF
Table 1: Capacitor Codes
Value µF Value IEC Code
100nF 0.1µF
100n
10nF 0.01µF 10n
220pF
NA
220p
EIA Code
104
103
221
150
C1d C2d
Fig.8: follow this parts layout diagram to build the PC board. The various
tables show the values for resistors Ra & Rb and for the filter components
(R1-R3 & C1-C2), while the linking options for the selection matrix are
shown at right. Links LK1 & LK2 go in position 1 for a dual-rail supply (or
for an AC supply) but must be moved to position 2 for a single-rail supply.
In summary, the three options for
powering the module are as follows:
(1) A dual-rail (plus & minus) supply
of between ±15V and ±60V (this connects to the “+” and “-’ supply inputs
of the terminal block);
(2) A single DC supply rail ranging
from 12-60V (this connects between
the “+” and “0V” supply inputs); and
(3) An AC supply ranging from 1243VAC (in this case, the “+” and “-”
inputs are tied together and the AC
supply is connected between these
IN
220pF
10k
EVIT CA
LK1
10k
1
R1d
15V
CON1
LPin
VR1
GND
10k
R1c
2 1
OUT
NI
HPin
IN
LPin
TU O
4.7 F NP
SIGNAL OUTPUT
LPout
OUT
HPout
LOW PASS
FILTER
commoned inputs and the 0V input).
In the case of a dual supply, diodes
D1 and D2 (1N4004) protect the circuit
against reverse polarity connection.
Zener diodes ZD1 and ZD2 then regulate the supply to provide ±15V rails
which are then used to power op amps
IC1-IC3. Two two 470µF capacitors
decouple the ±15V supply rails.
Resistors Ra & Rb are used to limit
the current into ZD1 and ZD2. The
values of these two resistors depend
on the input voltage (see Table 4 for
the required values).
In addition, for a dual supply, Earth
1 and Earth 2 are connected together
by installing jumper link LK2 in position 1 (LK1 must also be in position
1 or left out). With no signal, this sets
op amps IC1, IC2 & IC3 so that their
outputs sit at 0V.
For a single supply, ICs1-3 need to
GND
OUT
2
IN
R2d
470 F
1
100nF
47k
HPin LPout LEVEL
R3d
100 F
10nF
IC3
LM833
10k
ZD2
LK2
––
150
V0
–
10k
1
IC4
TL072
SUPPLY
0V
INPUT
470 F
R2c
+
R3c
+
C3b C2b
IC1
LM833
C2a C3a
15V
SIGNAL INPUT
4.7 F NP
10
1
IC2
LM833
RETLIF
R1a
R2a
10
Ra
ZD1
C1b
10
C1a
R2b
4004
R1b
D1
SINGLE SUPPLY: LK1=2, LK2 = 2
HPin
IN
LPin
LPout
OUT
HPout
HIGH PASS
FILTER
HPin
IN
LPin
LPout
OUT
HPout
BANDPASS
FILTER
be biased at half-supply so that the
signal can swing symmetrically without clipping. This half-supply rail is
provided by op amp IC4. As shown,
a half-supply voltage is derived using
two 10kΩ resistors in series across the
positive supply rail. This is decoupled
by a 100µF capacitor and then buffered
by IC4 to drive Earth 2 when LK2 is in
the “2” position.
In addition, for a single supply, the
negative supply pins for ICs1-3 are
connected to the 0V supply rail by
placing link LK1 in position 2.
Note that when LK2 is in position
2, the half-supply output from IC4
is bypassed to earth (0V) via a 10nF
capacitor. This prevents oscillation in
the filter op amps. The 150Ω resistor
at pin 6 of IC4 isolates the op amp’s
output from the capacitance in the
shielded output leads.
Table 2: Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
No.
1
1
1
1
4
2
2
2
2
3
64 Silicon Chip
Value
47kΩ
15kΩ
13kΩ
12kΩ
10kΩ
6.2kΩ
5.6kΩ
4.7kΩ
150Ω
10Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
yellow violet orange brown
brown green orange brown
brown orange orange brown
brown red orange brown
brown black orange brown
blue red red brown
green blue red brown
yellow violet red brown
brown green brown brown
brown black black brown
5-Band Code (1%)
yellow violet black red brown
brown green black red brown
brown orange black red brown
brown red black red brown
brown black black red brown
blue red black brown brown
green blue black brown brown
yellow violet black brown brown
brown green black black brown
brown black black gold brown
siliconchip.com.au
into
RF?
There’s something to suit every
radio frequency fan in the
SILICON CHIP reference bookshop
RF Circuit Design
– by Chris Bowick
A new edition of this classic RF
design text - tells how to design
and integrate RF components into
virtually any circuitry.
$
75
Practical RF H’book
– by Ian Hickman
A reference work for technicians,
engineers, students and the more
specialised enthusiast. Covers all
the key topics in RF that you
$
need to understand
90
Table 3: Filter Type Configuration
Low-Pass Filter
Link IN to LPin;
Link LPout to OUT
High-Pass Filter
Link IN to HPin;
Link HPout to OUT
Bandpass Filter
Link IN to HPin; Link HPout to LPin;
Link LPout to OUT
Table 4: Power Supply Configuration
Input Voltage
±60VDC, 43VAC
±55VDC, 40VAC
±50VDC, 35VAC
±45VDC, 30VAC
±40VDC, 28VAC
±35VDC, 25VAC
±30VDC, 20VAC
±25VDC, 18VAC
±20VDC, 15VAC
±15VDC, 11VAC
+30V
+25V
+20V
+15V
+12V
Ra
1.2kΩ 5W
1kΩ 5W
820Ω 5W
680Ω 5W
560Ω 5W
470Ω 5W
390Ω 5W
270Ω 5W
120Ω 1W
10Ω 0.5W
390Ω 5W
270Ω 5W
120Ω 1W
10Ω 1/2W
10Ω 1/2W
Rb
1.2kΩ 5W
1kΩ 5W
820Ω 5W
680Ω 5W
560Ω 5W
470Ω 5W
390Ω 5W
270Ω 5W
120Ω 1W
10Ω 0.5W
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
Finally, for an AC supply, D1 & D2
function as half-wave rectifiers to derive positive and negative supply rails.
The circuit then functions exactly the
same as for a dual-rail DC supply.
Construction
All parts for the Multi-Function Active Filter are mounted on a PC board
coded 01107091 and measuring 123
x 63mm. This can either be housed
inside a UB3 plastic utility case measuring 130 x 68 x 44mm or installed
within an amplifier case.
siliconchip.com.au
Links
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 1, LK2 position 1
LK1 position 2, LK2 position 2
LK1 position 2, LK2 position 2
LK1 position 2, LK2 position 2
LK1 position 2, LK2 position 2
LK1 position 2, LK2 position 2
Note that corner cutouts will be
required if mounting the board in a
utility case, to clear the integral mounting posts.
Fig.8 shows the parts layout on the
PC board. However, before starting
the assembly, you have to decide on
the power supply to be used, the type
of filter arrangement and the cutoff
frequency.
Table 4 shows the resistors (Ra &
Rb) required for various power supply
voltages, plus the LK1 & LK2 linking
options. The filter component values
Practical Guide To
Satellite TV
– by Garry Cratt
The reference written by an Aussie
for Aussie conditions.Everything
you need to know.
$
49
You’ll find many more technical
titles in the SILICON CHIP
reference bookshop – see
elsewhere in this issue
into
?
S
O
R
C
I
M
There’s something to suit every
microcontroller maestro in the
SILICON CHIP reference bookshop
Microcontroller LNEW
W
Projects in C wPRO
IC
as $ E!
– by Dogan Ibrahim
81
Graded projects introduce
microelectronics, the 8051
and programming in C.
$
60
Hands-On Zigbee
– by Fred Eady
An in-depth look at the clever little
chip that’s starting to be found in a
wide range of equipment from
consumer to
50
$
industrial.
96
Programming 16-Bit
Microcontrollers in C
– by Luci Di Jasio
Learning to fly the PIC24. Includes
a CD ROM with source code in C,
Microchip C30 complier $
and MPLAB SIM.
90
You’ll find many more technical
titles in the SILICON CHIP
reference bookshop – see
elsewhere in this issue
July 2009 65
Using The FilterPro Software From TI
Fig.9: this is how FilterPro should look when set up to calculate values for a
low-pass 2-pole Butterworth filter.
The first step here is to download the
2.848MB zipped file (available from http:
//focus.ti.com/docs/toolsw/folders/print/
filterpro.html) and run the FilterProSetup.
exe file. That done, navigate to C:\ProgramFiles\Ti Analog Design Centre\Filterpro
and create a shortcut on your desktop for
FilterPro.exe.
When you launch FilterPro, the program
will show a screen with a graph, the filter
circuit and various settings (see Fig.9). The
graph shows the frequency response of the
filter using an amplitude versus frequency
plot. The actual rolloff can be seen as well
as any excursions in the response across the
passband or at the cutoff frequency.
Calculating The Filter Component Values
C
HOOSING THE CROSSOVER FREQUENCIES for loudspeaker drivers
requires careful consideration.You will need the data sheet for each driver
in order to make a decision as to where the crossover frequency should lie.
Ideally, the crossover frequency should be well away from the driver’s resonance frequency and the adjacent drivers should be a good match to ensure
a smooth frequency response across the audio band.
Many books have been written on the subject and a good reference is
“The Loudspeaker Speaker Design Cookbook” by Vance Dickason. This
is available from Jaycar, Cat. BA-1400.
Once you have decided on the crossover frequencies, the filter component
values can be calculated. Tables 5 and 6 show the recommended values for
a range of common frequencies.
For other frequencies, you can download software off the net to make the
calculations easier. Our recommendation is to use “Filter Pro” from Texas
Instruments. You can download it from http://focus.ti.com/docs/toolsw/
folders/print/filterpro.html
If this site becomes unavailable, do a search for “Ti filter software” or for
“FilterPro”. Information on how to use FilterPro and other useful information
on filters is available at http://focus.ti.com/lit/an/sbfa001a/sbfa001a.pdf
An alternative on-line program is also available from Okawa Electric – see
the section entitled “Using the FilterPro Software From TI”.
66 Silicon Chip
Two other responses are also shown on
the graph: the phase response and the group
delay. The phase response plots the phase
variations in the filter output as a function
of frequency. By contrast, the group delay
shows the slope (or rate of change) in the
phase response and is ideal for displaying
the filter response to a pulse signal.
Several different filter types can also
be selected – ie, Bessel, Butterworth and
Chebychev. Each has a different “Q” value
and so the filter response differs from one
to the other.
Each filter type has its own advantages and
disadvantages. For example, a Bessel filter
has a Q of 0.577 (1/√3) and has a smooth
but drooping amplitude response across the
passband. It has very little pulse response
overshoot and its rolloff is not as steep as
for a Butterworth filter.
Butterworth filters have a “Q” of 0.7071
(1/√2) and have the flattest possible (max
imally flat) amplitude response in the passband and a moderate pulse response rise (or
overshoot) at the cutoff frequency.
A Chebychev filter has a higher Q again.
This filter has ripple in the passband, a
steeper cutoff rate and higher pulse response
overshoot compared to the two lower Q
filters. The Q value depends on the amount
of ripple that can be tolerated and is 0.956
for a 1dB passband ripple and 0.863 for a
0.5dB passband ripple.
A filter with a “Q” of 0.5 is critically
damped and shows no pulse response
overshoot. The Bessel, Butterworth and
Chebychev filters are all under-damped and
so each show some degree of overshoot in
its response. An over-damped filter would
have a “Q” of less than 0.5.
Butterworth filters
For audio work, the best compromise filter
type is the Butterworth, especially when two
filters are cascaded as in our Multi-Function
Active Filter. So in FilterPro, select “Butter-
are selected from Tables 5 & 6 (see also
the panel titled “Calculating The Filter
Component Values”).
Note that for the single supply option, Rb, D2, ZD2 & C5 can be omitted.
However, it does not matter if they are
installed. Alternatively, for a dual rail
supply option, IC4, R4, R5 & C6 are not
required. Note also that either 5W or
0.5W resistors can be used for Ra &
Rb, as the PC board accepts both types.
For a LP filter only, there is no need
to install the HP components. These
siliconchip.com.au
FilterPro provides values for the resistors
and capacitors using R1, R2 & R3 and C1,
C2 & C3 component designations. These are
easily equated with the component designations on the circuit diagram (Fig.7) and parts
layout diagram (Fig.7). Note: the a, b, c & d
designations on Fig.7 are there simply to
distinguish one filter circuit from another.
Bandpass filter
A bandpass filter is made by designing
two separate cascaded HP and LP circuits.
For example, if you want a bandpass filter
with rolloffs at 500Hz and 2kHz, you simply
use FilterPro to design independent 500Hz
high-pass and 2kHz low-pass stages.
Do not select a bandpass design in
FilterPro – the calculations are not applicable
to the Multi-Function Active Filter module
described here.
Alternative software
worth” as the filter type and select “2” for the
number of poles. The circuit type should be
set to “MFB single ended” and the set display
value should be “component values”.
For components, select “E24” series for
the resistors and either “E6” or “E12” for the
capacitors (these “E” series values select
the number of values available in a decade
range). The relevant resistor and capacitor
values will then be calculated based on readily
available components.
Note: some component suppliers may
not have the full E12 capacitor series. In that
case, a recalculation may have to be made
using the E6 series instead if using the E12
series gives components values that are
unavailable.
The next step is to enter the cutoff frequency, select either LP or HP and then click
on an unused section of the screen to start
calculating the values.
Note that the circuit for the multiple
feedback 2-pole filter shows the values for
a single 2-pole filter section. These same
values are also used in the second 2-pole
filter stage of the Multi-Function Active Filter.
If you want to use an alternative program
to FilterPro or if you want to check the predicted response of your filter using the values
given by FilterPro, a good on-line program is
one from Okawa Electric. For the low-pass
filter, go to http://sim.okawa-denshi.jp/en/
OPtazyuLowkeisan.htm For the high-pass
filter navigate to http://sim.okawa-denshi.
jp/en/OPtazyuHikeisan.htm
These sites not only allow you to calculate
filter components but also allow you to input
component values. The program will then
show the actual cutoff frequency, filter Q
and other features. These calculations can
sometimes give a better result (ie, closer to
the required Q and cutoff frequency) than
FilterPro.
Note, however, that the R1, R2, R3, C1,
C2 & C3 labelling is a little different to that
of the FilterPro and our circuit, so make sure
you transpose the labelling correctly. Also,
do not forget to tick the Q value field at 0.707
rather than using the ticked damping ratio
field of 1 for the calculation.
include IC2, R1a, R2a, C1a, C2a, C3a,
R1b, R2b, C1b, C2b & C3b. The two
10Ω stopper resistors can also be left
out (but not the one on pin 3 of IC1a).
Similarly, for a HP filter, you can
leave out LP components IC3, R1c,
R2c, R3c, C1c, C2c, R1d, R2d, R3d,
C1d & C2d.
Start the assembly by carefully
inspecting the board for any defects,
then install the four wire links. Alternatively, 0Ω resistors can be used
instead of the wire links. These look
similar to a 0.25W resistor but have
just one single black band around the
centre of the body.
Next, install four PC stakes at the input and output positions, then install
the resistors and trimpot VR1. Table 2
shows the resistor colour codes but a
digital multimeter should also be used
to check values, just to make sure.
Follow these with the diodes, zener
diodes and the ICs. These parts must
all be installed with the correct orientation. Note that IC4 is a different type
to IC1, IC2 & IC3, so don’t get it mixed
up. We used IC sockets for the ICs and
these sockets also have an orientation
notch at one end – see Fig.8.
The electrolytic capacitors are next
on the list and these must also be
oriented correctly. The only exceptions here are the two 4.7µF NP (nonpolarised) types which can go in either
way around.
Once these parts are in, install the
two 3-way SIL (Single In-Line) headers
for links LK1 & LK2. The two jumpers
Fig.10: the low-pass filter design software from Okawa Electric shows the
circuit values and filter responses in a similar way to FilterPro. A high-pass
filter design tool is also available from Okawa Electric – see text.
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 67
Table 5: High-Pass Filter Component Values (Butterworth Response)
Frequency
C1 (IEC Code) (EIA Code)
C2 (IEC Code) (EIA Code)
C3 (IEC Code) (EIA Code)
R1
R2
50Hz
100Hz
120Hz
150Hz
200Hz
300Hz
500Hz
1kHz
1.5kHz
2kHz
3kHz
5kHz
10kHz
20kHz
330nF (334)
150nF (154)
150nF (154)
100nF (104)
68nF (683)
47nF (473)
33nF (333)
15nF (153)
10nF (103)
6.8nF (6n8) (682)
6.8nF (6n8) (682)
3.3nF (3n3) (332)
1.5nF (1n5) (152)
680pF (681)
330nF (334)
150nF (154)
150nF (154)
100nF (104)
68nF (683)
47nF (473)
33nF (333)
15nF (153)
10nF (103)
6.8nF (6n8) (682)
6.8nF (6n8) (682)
3.3nF (3n3) (332)
1.5nF (1n5) (152)
680pF (681)
330nF (334)
150nF (154)
100nF (104)
100nF (104)
100nF (104)
68nF (683)
33nF (333)
15nF (153)
10nF (103)
10nF (103)
6.8nF (6n8) (682)
3.3nF (3n3) (332)
1.5nF (1n5) (152)
1nF (102)
20kΩ
22kΩ
24kΩ
22kΩ
20kΩ
20kΩ
20kΩ
22kΩ
22kΩ
20kΩ
20kΩ
20kΩ
22kΩ
20kΩ
4.3kΩ
5.1kΩ
4.7kΩ
5.1kΩ
4.7kΩ
4.7kΩ
4.3kΩ
5.1kΩ
5.1kΩ
4.7kΩ
4.7kΩ
4.3kΩ
5.1kΩ
4.7kΩ
Table 6: Low-Pass Filter Component Values (Butterworth Response)
Frequency
R1
R2
R3
50Hz
100Hz
120Hz
150Hz
200Hz
300Hz
500Hz
1kHz
1.5kHz
2kHz
3kHz
5kHz
10kHz
20kHz
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
4.7kΩ
5.6kΩ
6.2kΩ
6.2kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
6.2kΩ
6.2kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
6.2kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
4.7kΩ
5.6kΩ
6.2kΩ
6.2kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
6.2kΩ
6.2kΩ
5.6kΩ
5.6kΩ
6.2kΩ
12kΩ
15kΩ
12kΩ
13kΩ
15kΩ
13kΩ
12kΩ
15kΩ
13kΩ
15kΩ
13kΩ
12kΩ
15kΩ
15kΩ
C1 (IEC Code) (EIA Code) C2 (IEC Code) (EIA Code)
150n (154)
68nF (683)
68nF (683)
47nF (473)
33nF (33)
22nF (223)
15n (153)
6.8nF (6n8) (682)
4.7nF (4n7) (472)
3.3nF (3n3) (332)
2.2nF (2n2) (222)
1.5n (1n5) (152)
680pF (681)
330pF (331)
1µF (105)
470nF (474)
470nF (474)
330nF (334)
220nF (224)
150nF (154)
100nF (104)
47nF (473)
33nF (333)
22nF (223)
15nF (153)
10nF (103)
4.7nF (4n7) (472)
2.2nF (2n2) (222)
Be sure to choose the correct filter component values when building the PC
board – see Tables 5 & 6. In this case, the board has been configured as a highpass filter and is set up to accept dual supply rails.
68 Silicon Chip
can then be fitted to these headers.
They both go in position 1 for a dualrail supply (or if you are using an AC
supply) – see Table 4.
Alternatively, install them both in
position 2 if you intend using a single
rail supply.
The selection matrix requires a
3-way DIL (Dual In-Line) pin header
and this should now be installed – it
goes in just to the left of trimpot VR1.
Once it’s in, install the jumpers on this
header to select your filter type (ie, LP,
HP or bandpass).
The assembly can now be completed
by installing the 3-way screw terminal
block.
Power supply checks
Before applying power, check that
the supply link options are correct (see
Table 4) and that the correct values
have been installed for resistors Ra &
Rb. Check also that you’ve installed the
correct link options for the filter type.
Next, connect one probe of your
DMM to the 0V supply input, apply
power and use the other probe to
measure the supply voltages on the
ICs. For a dual (±) or AC supply
arrangement, check that there is
+15V on pin 8 of ICs1-4. Similarly, there should be -15V on pin
4 of ICs1-3, while pin 4 of IC4 (if
installed) should be at 0V.
For the single supply arrangement,
check for +15V on pin 8 of ICs1-3 and
on pin 7 of IC4 (if installed). Note that
the measured voltage will be lower if
the supply voltage is less than 15V.
Pin 6 of IC4 should be at half-supply
SC
(eg, 7.5V for a 15V supply).
siliconchip.com.au
STIC
FANTAIDEA
GIFT UDENTS
FOR SFT ALL
O S!
AGE
THEAMATEUR SCIENTIST
An incredible CD with over 1000 classic projects
from the pages of Scientific American,
covering every field of science...
NEW VERSION 4 –
JUST RELEASED!
GET THE LATEST
VERSION NOW!
Arguably THE most IMPORTANT collection
of scientific projects ever put together!
This is version 4, Super Science Fair Edition
from the pages of Scientific American.
As well as specific project material, the CDs
contain hints and tips by experienced amateur
scientists, details on building
science apparatus, a large
database of chemicals and
so much more.
ONLY
62
$
00
PLUS $10 Pack and Post
within Australia
NZ P&P: $AU12.00,
Elsewhere: $AU18.00
“A must for every science student,
science teacher, science lab . . . or simply
for those with an enquiring mind . . .”
Just a tiny selection of the incredible range of projects:
! Build a seismograph to study earthquakes ! Make soap bubbles that last for
months ! Monitor the health of local streams ! Preserve biological specimens !
Build a carbon dioxide laser ! Grow bacteria cultures safely at home ! Build a
ripple tank to study wave phenomena ! Discover how plants grow in low gravity !
Do strange experiments with sound ! Use a hot wire to study the crystal structure
of steel ! Extract and purify DNA in your kitchen !Create a laser hologram ! Study
variable stars like a pro ! Investigate vortexes in water ! Cultivate slime moulds !
Study the flight efficiency of soaring birds ! How to make an Electret ! Construct
fluid lenses ! Raise butterflies as experimental animals ! Study the physics of
spinning tops ! Build an apparatus for studying chaotic systems ! Detect metals in
air, liquids, or solids ! Photograph an ant's brain and nervous system ! Use
magnets to make fluids into solids ! Measure the metabolism of an insect . . . !
and many, many more (a thousand more, in fact!)
See the V2 review in SILICON CHIP, October 2004. . . or read on line at siliconchip.com.au
This is the ALL-NEW Version 4 . . . it’s even BETTER!
HERE’S HOW TO ORDER YOUR COPY:
BY PHONE:*
(02) 9939 3295
9-5 Mon-Fri
BY FAX:#
<at>
(02) 9939 2648
24 Hours 7 Days
BY EMAIL:#
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
24 Hours 7 Days
BY MAIL:#
BY PAYPAL:#
PO Box 139,
Collaroy NSW 2097
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
24 Hours 7 Days
* Please have your credit card handy! # Don’t forget to include your name, address, phone no and credit card details.
BY INTERNET:^
siliconchip.com.au
24 Hours 7 Days
^ You will be prompted for required information
There’s also a handy order form inside this issue.
Exclusive in SILICON
Australia to: CHIP siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 69
CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK
Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions from
readers are welcome and will be paid for at standard rates.
SMALL
TELESCOPIC
ANTENNA
4.7k
4.7k
G2
L1
TUNING
VR1
VC2 5k
VC1
LIN
GAIN
G1
Q1
B
D
470
10nF
560
10nF
OUTPUT
TO SONY
7600G
Q2
E
S
10nF
C
10k
100k
B
C
9V
BATTERY
E
Q3
L1: 35T CLOSE WOUND
ON 10mm DIAMETER
FORMER
VC1, VC2: BOTH SECTIONS OF
A PLASTIC DIELECTRIC
AM TUNING CAPACITOR
10nF
Q1: 40673, 3N211, 3N212 ETC.
RF preamplifier for
world-band receivers
Synthesised world-band receivers
are very popular but they do suffer
generally from poor reception with
the standard telescopic aerial. The
radios are very sensitive by themselves but the aerial is far too short
on the lower shortwave bands to
supply any reasonable signal for
good reception, the result being hiss
and noise.
Wideband RF stages do not lend
themselves to being connected to
large antennas and usually suffer
from overloading and cross modulation problems. The circuit described
here combines modest gain with a
tuned RF stage to help reduce outof-band signals.
Inductor L1 and plastic dielectric
variable capacitor VC1 comprise a
tuned circuit, resonant to the band
of interest. Dual-gate MOSFET Q1
then buffers the high impedance of
the tuned circuit and also provides
some gain which is limited by its
unbypassed 470Ω source resistor.
Transistor Q2 functions as an emitter
follower to buffer the drain output of
the MOSFET before it is fed into the
antenna input of the radio.
Q3 functions as a switch, automatically turning the preamplifier
on when the radio is activated.
The Sony ICF7600GR, the radio for
which this circuit was developed,
has approximately 3.5V present at
the external antenna input when
switched on. This voltage will turn
Q3 fully on via its 10kΩ bias resistor,
thereby connecting the 9V internal
supply of the preamp.
The overall gain is adjusted by
VR1, allowing approximately +6dB
gain when wound fully clockwise.
When rotated fully anticlockwise,
Q2,Q3: BC547
Q1: 3N211/212
B
E
G1
C
G2
S
D
VR1 will attenuate the signal by
around the same amount, which is
very useful with strong signals.
Other world-band radios may not
have this external antenna voltage
present, in which case Q3 can be
omitted and a normal switch used
instead. The current drain is around
10mA and a small 9V battery will
provide many hours of operation.
Inductor L1 is wound using 35
turns of enamelled wire (scrounged
from a small transformer) on part
of a ballpoint pen case. The tuning
capacitor can be recycled from a
defunct transistor radio, as can the
gain control pot and telescopic aerial. The circuit can be constructed
on a scrap of copper circuit board
and housed in a small zippy box.
A short cable is made to connect to
the radio’s external antenna input.
Dayle Edwards,
Westland, New Zealand. ($45)
C h o o s e Yo u r P r i z e
There are now five great reasons to
send in your circuit idea for publication
in SILICON CHIP. We pay for each item
published or better still, the best item in
“Circuit Notebook” each month will entitle
the author to choose one of four prizes:
(1) an LCR40 LCR meter, (2) a DCA55
Semiconductor Component Analyser, (3)
an ESR60 Equivalent Series Resistance
Analyser or (4) an SCR100 Thyristor &
Triac Analyser, with the compliments of
70 Silicon Chip
Peak Electronic Design Ltd. See their
website at www.peakelec.co.uk
So now you have even more reasons
to send that brilliant circuit in. Send it to
SILICON CHIP and you could be a winner.
You can either email your idea to
silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au or post it to
PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
siliconchip.com.au
+5V
Signal inverter runs
from a 5V rail
This circuit is designed to be a
basic signal inverter. It takes a negative or positive-going voltage signal
and inverts it.
The circuit consists of a 741 op
amp (IC1) and a 555 timer (IC2).
IC2 runs as an astable multivibrator
which drives a diode pump circuit
consisting of diodes D1 & D2 and the
1µF & 22µF capacitors. This generates the negative supply rail for the
741 op amp which otherwise could
not deliver a negative polarity signal.
Hence IC1 has positive and negative supply rails, as needed for normal operation. It is connected as an
inverting amplifier stage with unity
gain, as determined by the 10kΩ
input and feedback resistors.
Note that there are no signal
coupling capacitors in the circuit,
necessary to ensure that the op amp
can deliver DC output signals. With
no input signal applied, there will be
NEGATIVE
VOLTAGE
INPUT
(TO BE
INVERTED)
10k
7
2
3
IC1
741
6
4
1k
7
6
1k
8
4
3
IC2
555
2
100nF
5
D2
1 F
K
A
–
D1
1
10nF
100 F
A
+
K
22 F
0V
D1,D2: 1N4004
A
a slight DC offset error at the output
of the op amp.
The original use for this circuit
was to invert the signal from an AD
595 thermocouple decoder, which
Twin-tub washing machines are economical in water
usage but do have drawbacks. Having to manually fill
the spin side with water for final rinse requires continual monitoring otherwise there is the risk of water
overflowing onto the floor. The resultant slippery floor
can be a hazard unless it is mopped up immediately.
This circuit was designed to detect moisture on the
laundry floor, with the sensor placed directly under
the washing machine.
In essence, the circuit uses two NPN transistors in
a Darlington configuration. The base of the first transistor, Q1, is fed via the moisture sensor and a 10kΩ
resistor. If there is no moisture present, the transistor
is held off by the 1MΩ resistor connected from the base
to the 0V line.
Once the resistance of the moisture sensor falls below about 4MΩ, Q1 will turn on as will Q2 and this
powers the piezo alarm. It will continue to beep for
about 15 seconds until the 2200µF supply capacitor
is discharged. The 2200µF capacitor is charged by the
56kΩ resistor from the 9V battery supply. When the
sensor has been dried out completely, the circuit can
be used again and recharging of the 2200µF capacitor
will take about five minutes.
When the moisture sensor is open-circuit (ie, no
moisture is present), the standby current is almost
solely dependent on the leakage of the electrolytic
capacitor. For a good capacitor, this should only be
K
delivers negative voltages for negative temperatures but there are many
other applications.
Reuben Posthuma,
Christchurch, New Zealand. ($35)
Simple water
spillage alarm
siliconchip.com.au
POSITIVE
VOLTAGE
OUTPUT
(TO ADC
OR SIMILAR)
10k
56k
2200 F
16V
10k
10k
SENSOR
B
C
E
1M
+
PIEZO
SOUNDER
–
Q1
BC548
B
1M
C
E
9V
BATTERY
Q2
BC548
BC548
B
E
C
a few microamps so battery life should be very long.
Any general-purpose small-signal silicon NPN
transistors can be used. The alarm sounder is a Jaycar
AB-3456 with the yellow and black leads connected for
pulse (beep) operation. The red lead is not connected.
The sensor is made up from a strip of Veroboard,
with alternate tracks bridged together and 1mm copper
wire strips soldered along the tracks to keep the board
slightly raised off the floor. The sensor is then lacquered
and the wire strips slightly sanded for exposure to floor
contact. The circuit, 9V battery and sounder were fitted
into a small plastic utility box (UB5) with a circular
cut-out for the alarm.
Warwick Talbot,
Toowoomba, Qld. ($40)
July 2009 71
Circuit Notebook – Continued
+12V
100nF
16
Vdd
100nF
O0
O3
O4
10
K
ZD1
12V
CP
O5
22k
O6
4.7nF
O9
O10
10k
11
O11
MR
O12
O13
Vss
15
7
1
5
2
4
8
14
6
13
14
O6
3
4
2
4
7
O3
14
6
IC3b
CP0
O2
O1
5
13
IC2: 4023B
IC3: 4025B
3
CP1
Vss
8
D3
D1
K
11
9
9
8
6
7
5
6
1
5
IC4
4017B O4 10
9
IC3a
8
3
O5
14
1
2
6
IC2b
5
15
1
O9
O7
A
O0
4
7
3
4
2
2
1
3
0
A
16
A
9V
K
A
K
+12V
1000 F
A
O5
RESET
100nF
(MOM)
O3
–
A
LED2
START
A
13
D1-D3: 1N4148
K
This timer is very accurate, has
long-term stability and requires no
calibration. It does not use a crystalcontrolled oscillator or a PIC with an
internal resonator. Instead, it uses
the 50Hz mains to derive its clock
pulses. In the form presented here
it is a kitchen minute timer but the
design can be extended to include
seconds or hours as required.
Power is provided by a 9V AC
plugpack which is rectified to supply a DC voltage of between 12V &
13V. When power is first applied,
A
PIEZO
BUZZER
O2
B
10k
K
CP1
Vss
8
10
11
IC3c
9
8
6
7
5
6
1
5
O0
4
7
3
4
2
2
1
3
0
1N4004
A
all counters are automatically reset.
Switch S1 is a DPDT (double-pole,
double-throw) type with a centre-off
position. One side is a momentary
contact which is used to reset the
timer. The other side of S1 provides
power to the alarm which will sound
at the end of the timing period. It also
provides half-wave rectified 50Hz
pulses via diode D1 to IC1, a 4020
14-bit binary counter. The centreoff position will turn off the alarm
which will sound continuously until
attended to.
The 50Hz pulses are fed to the
clock input (pin 10) of IC1 after
signal conditioning by an RC filter
K
S2
MINUTES
x10
O5-9
12
10
12
11
IC2c
12
7 13
13
E
K
Accurate timer locked
to 50Hz mains supply
72 Silicon Chip
C
Q1
K
ZD1
CP0
O1
A
9
11
IC5
4017B O4 10
560
O9
O6
START
S3b
+
LED1
POWER
100nF
O7
100nF
560
MR
1M
14
9V AC
PLUGPACK
Vdd
O8
A
A
K
15
S3a
D4-D7: 1N4004
K
+12V
D2
START
S1
MINUTES
x1
O5-9
12
K
1M
230V
MR
O8
8
K
Vdd
9
IC2a
100nF
16
9
O7
IC1
4020B O8 12
A
100nF
Q1: BC548
B
E
LEDS
C
K
A
(22kΩ & 4.7nF) and clipping by zener
diode ZD1. Since we are interested
in obtaining a 1-minute interval, IC1
is used to count 3000 of the 20ms
pulses from D1. A count of 3000 in
binary is 101110111000 so we need
to detect when outputs Q4, Q5, Q6,
Q8, Q9, Q10 & Q12 are simultaneously high. This is achieved using
NAND gates IC2a & IC2b and NOR
gates IC3b & IC3a. The output of IC3a
supplies a reset pulse to IC1 and
clocks decade counter IC4, a 4017.
IC4 counts single minutes and
on reaching a count of 10, resets
itself and advances the count on
IC5 which counts 10s of minutes.
siliconchip.com.au
m
y Graha
Geoffre onth’s
is this m of a
winner Test
las
Peak At ent
u
r
t
Ins m
The enhanced software for the
Appliance Energy Meter provides a
much wider range of information,
including predicted energy usage,
predicted cost and CO2 emissions.
Enhanced software
for the Appliance
Energy Meter
The Appliance Energy Meter described in the July & August 2004
issues has been popular and is still
available in kit form from Altronics
(Cat. K4600). The original firmware
was written in assembler and could
only display a limited number of
measurements (watts, accumulated
kWh and cost).
This replacement firmware is
written in the C language and uses
32-bit floating point routines to
provide a much wider range of information, including predictions of
the energy cost over time and CO2
emissions. The above diagram shows
all the readings that you can call up.
To install the new firmware you
need to replace the original PIC16F628 microcontroller with a PIC16F88-I/P. The 16F88 is pin-forpin compatible with the original
microcontroller but has double the
program memory and this is used to
implement the new functions.
The only function of the original
design that the new firmware does
not cater for is brownout detection.
As compensation, you get a much
faster update rate (every second)
compared to the original design
(every 11 seconds).
To install the new firmware, sim-
ply download the HEX file from the
SILICON CHIP website, program it into
a PIC16F88-I/P microcontroller and
install it in the Appliance Energy
Meter. No other modifications are
required.
To reset the meter and start accumulating a new set of readings
you press the CLEAR button. The
FUNCTION button will step you
down through the five “layers” of
readings as shown in the diagram.
The UP and DOWN buttons will step
you right or left on a horizontal line.
To set up the meter you hold down
the CLEAR button for five or more
seconds and the display will change
to the calibration settings. To adjust
a setting, use the UP and DOWN buttons as required. To step to the next
setting, press the FUNCTION button.
When you have run through all the
calibration settings the display will
revert to normal measurement.
In total, there are five calibration
settings: cost of electricity, number
of days between electricity bills, the
rate of CO2 emissions per kWH (your
electricity supplier can tell you this
– check their website), zero setting
and calibration factor. If you wrote
down the settings for the last two
in the original firmware, you can
re-enter the numbers here. Alternatively, refer to the original article for
details on setting them.
The firmware predicts energy usage by averaging the readings over
time. For something that draws constant power, the prediction is accurate after a few seconds but for
an appliance that varies its power
(like a fridge) you will need to leave
it connected for a few days until
the predictions settle to a constant
value.
You can use this technique to
measure the real cost of running
many appliances, including your
computer, water pump and even
your electric kettle. For example,
you can connect this to your “power
hungry” plasma TV and after a while
it will have averaged the on/off times
dictated by your viewing habits.
You can then display how much
it will cost you per bill, per year and
even how much it will contribute to
global warming.
Geoffrey Graham,
Perth, W.A.
Note: all parts in the Appliance
Energy Meter (including the display) operate at 230VAC. Be sure to
disconnect it from the mains before
opening the lid.
The timer is consequently capable
of timing intervals up to 99 minutes.
The time interval is set by switches
S2 & S3 which select the appropriate
outputs of IC4 and IC5.
When the selected outputs are
both high, this condition is detected
by NAND gate IC2c and inverted
by IC3c. The resulting high input
is applied to pin 13 of IC4, inhibiting further counting. The high also
turns on BC548 transistor Q1 which
sounds the buzzer.
The buzzer continues to sound
until power is removed from the
buzzer circuit by returning switch
S1 to its centre-OFF position.
As output 10 of IC2c is high
throughout the timing period, it
could be used to control a relay
which would switch a device on for
the timing period.
Jack Holliday,
Nathan, Qld. ($55)
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 73
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
SILICON
CHIP
If you are seeing a blank page here, it is
more than likely that it contained advertising
which is now out of date and the advertiser
has requested that the page be removed to
prevent misunderstandings.
Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website:
www.altronics.com.au/
A quick look at Australia’s largest IT show . . .
CeBIT 2009
by Ross Tester
T
o stand out from the crowd
(and believe me, it can be very
crowded at CeBIT) you need
something different. Whether that is
a “wow!” stand (and there were a few
of those) or a “gee whiz!” product, you
needed something to stop the passersby passing by . . .
At the very least you need something to make visitors remember you,
your stand, your products or at least
your name.
Bags displaying a name or logo
(or both) are very popular, if only to
carry home all the brochures before
they’re put in the recycling bin. Last
year, I recall one of the stands handing out monster-sized yellow bags.
Everywhere you looked, you saw those
bags. The smaller bags that everyone
else handed out were stuffed inside
the big bags! I also recall talking to the
stand staff and their philosophy was
simple: the guys with the biggest bags
win. Yep, they won at least as far as
exposure was concerned.
While there was none of that this
year (an edict from the organisers,
maybe?), the NSW Government stand
certainly took the prize for the bestbag-at-show. None of your Woolies
and Coles bio-degradable politically
correct bags here: your taxes went into
a you-beaut, zippered (waterproof?)
bag complete with compartments for
your mobile phone and business cards.
(And there were a lot of those bags with
similar-sized bags crammed into them
so I guess they won this year!).
But of course, CeBIT is much more
than bags. It’s about getting your message out to those who are interested
(or might become interested if you’re a
good talker) into buying your product
or service.
To be frank, I find it hard to comprehend the number of stands at shows
like CeBIT all trying to flog the same
type of products. There were countless
78 Silicon Chip
companies selling countless software
applications – it would appear that
anything that started with an “e” was
available: emarketing, ecommerce,
elearning, etracking, epayments, ehr
(how you can have e human resources
is a bit beyond me) and so much more –
even egovernment, courtesy of Kevin’s
sales team.
I noticed a lot more companies specialising in wireless – long range wifi
figured prominently once again, as did
several companies specialising in the
“nuts and bolts” of wireless LANs and
WANs, everything from the electronics
right down to the connectors.
And there were the ubiquitous
“sign up now special CeBIT deals”
for all manner of goods and services.
Not the least was “only while show
lasts” broadband special offers. I’m
not convinced those people going to
CeBIT would fit the demographic of
wanting to switch ISPs etc but given
If you look closely, you might notice
the new “Shuttle X50” all-in-one PC...
it’s due to go on sale at the same time
as this issue of SILICON CHIP.
the number of them and the fact that
they come back year after year, they
must figure it’s worth it.
One such company I spoke to (who
must, of course, remain nameless) said
that they were definitely questioning
their CeBIT attendance next year. They
had already reduced the size of their
stand to a quarter what it used to be,
mainly because the number of leads
had been steadily decreasing over the
past three years. They had over 500
the first year and were even happy
with the 350 the following year. Last
year it was down to 250 and when I
talked to them late on the second day,
their follow-up book had just over a
hundred entries in it.
That’s a pretty expensive form of
advertising, even if – and it’s a big if
– those hundred are quality leads. It’s
not just the floor space (expensive!)
but building and fitting out the stand
(expensive!) staffing it for the four days
(expensive!) . . . you get the picture.
CeBIT, held from May 10-12, occupied three halls at Sydney Convention
and Exhibition Centre so it’s no small
show! It’s broken down into quite a
number of areas which specialise in
certain fields – for example, VOIP,
networking, wireless, telecoms, smart
cards, RFID, POS, navigation, IT security, business software (almost a
whole hall), data centres, IT hardware,
financial services and so on.
Then there were the various Government stalls (Australian, state and
overseas) which, given their large
budgets, mostly had the largest areas.
Many of the big players in the IT
game were present but many were
conspicuous by their absence. One of
the big boys that was there, raising my
eyebrows at least, was Google. When a
company name has entered the lexicon
as a noun and verb in its own right (you
don’t search on line any more, you
Google!), one wonders which market
siliconchip.com.au
they were addressing at CeBIT!
Newsprout, an ISP based on the
north coast of NSW, had an interesting gimmick: handing out tiny plants
(Vibirnum, a very hardy, easily grown
shrub in any sunny or partly shaded
position with moist well-drained soil,
if you were wondering!) – in keeping
with their name. A lot of their push
was “green” but they also claimed to
be able to keep up with the big boys
when it came to service and speed.
(www.newsprout.com.au).
One of the most popular stands, at
least at the time I was there, was Altech
Computers. They had quite a variety
of “new and unusual” products but
the one that took my eye was the very
new “Shuttle” X50 all-in-one PC. It’s
a 15.6-inch LCD touchscreen with the
PC built in. No keyboard, no mouse.
It suits a wide range of applications
including digital signage, kiosks, etc.
It was so new at the time they only
had one in the country – the one on
display – but they expected stock to arrive around now (www.altech.com.au)
The CSIRO had a rather interesting
stand, not only because of the variety
of applications displayed but also because of the experts they had on the
stand to explain the applications and
what the CSIRO is doing. Of particular
interest was one of the Government’s
big “pushes” at the moment, broadband to the bush: the CSIRO has developed a wireless system which uses
existing infrastructure to deliver 12
megabit/s internet access up to 100km
from the antenna. An upgraded system
will deliver over 50 megabits/s. (www.
csiro.au).
One tiny stand (the smallest available!) had a real show-stopper, at least
if the show crowds stopping were
They reckoned this notebook case was
rugged enough to go onto building sites
and be walked on, even driven over!
siliconchip.com.au
any guide. Scinet are the Australian
distributors for Dino-Lite handheld
microscopes, which plug into a USB
port. I was impressed with the veryclose-up display of PC board soldering.
They had two models on display, both
priced under $500 and they seemed
to give a very good account of themselves. (www.scinet.com.au)
IT security, both data and hardware,
was featured heavily. With laptop/
notebook sales now far exceeding
desktop machines, Trace Technologies were proudly showing off their
“Laptop Cop” system which not only
lets you find out where your stolen
laptop is (they claim to within 15m
via cell triangulation!) but lets you
control it when the crook uses it on
the ‘net for the first time – without
the thief’s knowledge. So you can
remotely delete or retrieve important
or sensitive files, then get it back (and
hopefully apprehend the thief). (www.
tracetechnologies.com.au)
Another “felon”-related application was the Federal Government’s
“CrimTrac” system – the awardwinning crime-fighting tool. CrimTrac
was established to allow police forces
across Australia to share information,
to solve crimes and catch criminals.
It’s now evolved into a national
automated fingerprint ID system, a
national criminal investigation DNA
database, a national Child Sex Offender register and a national Police
Reference System providing rapid
access to operational policing data.
CrimTrac’s record is already very impressive and we hope to provide more
insight into this system in the future.
(www.crimtrac.gov.au)
Data recovery was also a feature
– and we plan to look at this area in
significantly more detail in the future.
One company was demonstrating its
approach to the subject with a number
of open, spinning hard drives. I don’t
think Xyber Data Recovery expects
them to ever work again but they
looked impressive. As well as hard
disks, they also extract data from bent
flash, tape, RAID and so on. (www.
xyber.com.au)
Away from the halls was another
part of CeBIT, the virtually continuous
seminars and presentations by and for
industry luminaries. We didn’t have
the time to attend any of these but
if the number of press releases they
generated is any guide, they were well
received. There were also numerous
Scinet’s Dino-lite handheld (or in this
case stand-held) USB microscopes.
anyone-can-attend seminars held
inside the CeBIT display halls, of
particular note those of telecoms guru
Paul Budde. We did manage to poke
our head into one of these, if only for
a few minutes. When deadlines loom,
seminars are an unaffordable luxury.
Overall?
One of the main reasons we look
at shows like CeBIT (and let’s face it,
CeBIT is the largest such show in Australia) is to see where the IT industry is
up to and to keep abreast of the latest
and greatest products.
From that point of view, CeBIT was,
with some exceptions, disappointing this year. Sure, there was lots of
razamatazz but there wasn’t all that
much in the way of innovation.
But as we said earlier, we go to keep
abreast of the “IT” times and from that
point of view, quite worthwhile. SC
We spotted these earphones (?) on the
Korean Business stand. They don’t
go in the ear but on the ear, allowing
you to still hear ambient sound (eg,
sirens). They sounded good, too!
July 2009 79
Calibrating, Setting
the Battery Capacit
Last month we presented the full description, operation and
construction details of our new Battery Capacity Meter.
This month we guide you through the once-only setup and
calibration. We also explain in detail how to use it!
Part 2 – by Mauro Grassi
A
SSUMING YOU have completed the Battery Capacity
Meter and installed it in its
case, now it’s time to calibrate it and
set it up, ready for use.
We’ve also shown the various LCD
readouts and what they mean – sorry
the type is so tiny but we had to get
a lot of information in!
After use, most of these screen
messages and sub-menus will become very much self-explanatory
and common sense. And you can
always refer back to this article if
you need to!
One Time Calibration
To calibrate the meter, you will
need to follow these steps:
(1) Measure the voltage between pin
2 (GND) and pin 1 (+5V Rail)
of CON4 using a DMM. Note
this voltage and enter it in the
CALIBRATION>Set +5V Rail
SubMenu;
(2) Measure the voltage between pin
2 (GND) and pin 5 (Low Battery
Voltage) of CON4 using a DMM.
Note this voltage and enter it in
the CALIBRATION>Calibrate
Lo. Divider SubMenu;
(3) Measure the voltage between pin
2 (GND) and pin 6 (High Battery
Voltage) of CON4 using a DMM.
Note this voltage and enter it in
the CALIBRATION>Calibrate
Hi. Divider SubMenu;
(4) Enter the value of your shunt
resistance (in mΩ) in the
80 Silicon Chip
STANDBY Mode: This flashes periodically when the meter is in standby mode. It
goes into Standby mode when the load & charge currents are below the set threshold.
USB must be disconnected for this to occur. In Standby mode, the meter consumes
minimal power, turning the LCD backlight off. Use S1to bring the meter out of standby.
SHUTDOWN Mode: This message appears briefly before the meter shuts down due
to the battery voltage being lower than the shutdown voltage. This is a fail-safe way
of protecting the battery. For example, a 12V SLA battery, should not be discharged
below 11V.
TURN METER OFF SubMenu Message: This message appears briefly if you've
requested to turn off the meter manually by going to the 'Turn Meter Off' submenu
and confirmed the action but the USB is connected. Since power is delivered through
the USB, the meter cannot perform the requested action.
This shows the typical view of a menu. A Submenu is enclosed in '<' and '>' brackets.
Here the top two entries of the Main Menu are shown. You can press 'A' and 'B' to go
up and down the menu and the corresponding number to enter the SubMenu. For
example, pressing 1 here takes you to the Battery SubMenu. The strings scroll from
right to left to show the entire name of the SubMenu.
The typical view of a SubMenu as a sequence of snapshots from top to bottom. A
submenu item that has no other SubMenus is enclosed in '[' and ']' brackets.
Top two entries of the System SubMenu are shown. Press 'A' and 'B' to go up and
down the SubMenu and the corresponding number to enter the SubMenu – eg,
pressing 1 takes you to the Beeper Status SubMenu to enable or disable the beep.
The strings scroll from right to left to show the entire name of the SubMenu, as well
as any values of the relevant settings. This sequence shows how the SubMenu items
scroll from right to left and how the value of the setting is shown in the scrolling
string. The top line contains the string 'Beeper Status: On' indicating that the beeper
system is enabled. You can change it by pressing 1. The bottom line contains the
string 'Average Samples: 30.0' indicating that presently, 30 readings are averaged at
a time. You can change the number of readings that are averaged by pressing 2. If
you changed the number of average samples to 120, then on returning to this
SubMenu, the bottom string would read 'Average Samples: 120.0' instead.
For numerical settings, enter the new value by using the number keys, the key '*' is
for a decimal point & the key 'D' is used as backspace if you make a mistake in
typing ('D' is for Delete). When you are satisfied with the entered value, press the
'#' key to enter the value. If no input is entered but you then press the '#' key to exit,
the current value of the setting is retained.
For values which are not numerical, you use the 'A' and 'B' keys to vary the value up
and down, respectively, and use the '#' key to exit the SubMenu.
Most settings are numerical, where the range is also shown and you must enter a
number in the valid range for the new value to be accepted.
Here are the various system messages and their meanings. Also shown is a
sequence of screens depicting how the SubMenus appear on the LCD readout.
siliconchip.com.au
Up & Using
ty Meter
PERCENT CHARGE
PRESS '1'
BATTERY CAPACITY
AMP HOURS
PRESS '2'
BATTERY VOLTAGE
VOLTS
PRESS '3'
LOAD CURRENT
AMPS
PRESS '4'
CHARGE CURRENT
AMPS
PRESS '5'
NET CURRENT
AMPS
PRESS '6'
TIME REMAINING
IF DISCHARGING
PRESS '7'
TIME CHARGING
IF CHARGING
PERCENT CHARGE
PRESS '8'
BATTERY VOLTAGE
CIRCUIT CURRENT
MILLIAMPS
PRESS '9'
RELAY CURRENT
MILLIAMPS
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
CALIBRATION>Shunt Resistance SubMenu;
Enter the CALIBRATION> Calibrate Current SubMenu. Apply
a small load of say a few amps
to the LOAD terminal through a
DMM. Note the current registered
on the DMM and enter it;
Enter the value of the gain of
the load amplifier (usually 60.0
for the MAX4080SASA) in the
CALIBRATION>Load Amp.
Gain SubMenu;
Enter the value of the gain of the
charge amplifier (usually 60.0
for the MAX4080SASA) in the
CALIBRATION>Charge Amp.
Gain SubMenu;
Enter the value of your sense
resistance (usually 10Ω) in the
CALIBRATION>Sense Resistance SubMenu;
Enter the CALIBRATION>Detect
Sense Resistance SubMenu. Connect the DMM in series between
the GND terminal of the meter
and the negative battery terminal.
Note the instantaneous circuit
siliconchip.com.au
current and enter it (in mA).
That completes the calibration.
One-time user setup
After the calibration is performed, you should run through
the following checklist to set up
your preferences:
(1) Go to the BATTERY SubMenu;
(2) Enter the full capacity of your
battery in the Battery Capacity
SubMenu;
(3) Enter Peukert’s constant in the
Peukert’s Constant SubMenu
if you are using a Lead Acid
battery;
(4) Enter the cell chemistry in the
Cell Chemistry SubMenu;
(5) Enter the charging efficiency
in the Charging Efficiency
SubMenu;
(6) Enter the cycle threshold in
the Cycle Threshold SubMenu;
(7) Exit the BATTERY SubMenu;
(8) Go to the DISPLAY SubMenu
and set up the display backlight
preferences like brightness and
time out period;
CHARGE CURRENT
AMPS
PRESS 'A'
LOAD CURRENT
AMPS
PERCENT CHARGE
PRESS 'B'
CHARGE/DISCHARGE
CYCLES
BATTERY VOLTAGE
VOLTS
PRESS 'C'
BATTERY CURRENT
AMPS
BATTERY CAPACITY
AMP-HOURS
PRESS 'D'
LOAD CURRENT
AMPS
BATTERY CAPACITY
WATT-HOURS
PRESS '*'
LOAD POWER
WATTS
PRESS '0' TO SEE ALL READINGS, IN SCROLLING MODE. PRESS
'#' TO ENTER THE MENU SYSTEM AND CHANGE SETTINGS.
This shows all the available readings.
Each is chosen by a single digit press on
the alphanumeric keypad. For example,
if you wish to display the battery voltage,
type ‘3’. Or if you wish to see the battery
capacity in Watt Hours and the load in
Watts, press ‘*’. Notice that from here, you
may press ‘#’ to enter the extensive menu
system. The remaining panels illustrate in
detail the various submenus.
July 2009 81
(9) Go to the DETECTION SubMenu;
(10) Enter the voltage below which to shut down in the
ShutDown Voltage SubMenu;
(11) Enter the low capacity alarm threshold in the Capacity Alarm SubMenu;
(12) Enter the standby current threshold in the Standby
Threshold SubMenu;
(13) Enter the trickle current threshold in the Trickle Current SubMenu;
(14) Enter the minimum voltage of your battery in the
Min. Voltage SubMenu;
(15) Enter the maximum voltage of your battery in the Max.
Voltage SubMenu;
(16) Enter the Detection Period and number of detection
points in the Detection Period and Detection Points
SubMenus;
(17) Exit the Detection SubMenu;
(18) Enter the SYSTEM SubMenu;
(19) Choose whether to enable or disable the audible alarm
in the Beeper Status SubMenu;
(20) Choose the number of samples to average in the Average Samples SubMenu;
(21) Exit the SYSTEM SubMenu;
(22) Enter the RELAY SubMenu;
(23) Choose whether you will use an external relay in the
Relay System SubMenu;
(24) If you are not using a relay, go to step 29; otherwise
continue.
(25) Enter the relay coil resistance in the Relay Coil Resistance SubMenu;
(26) Enter the overload current and its duration in the Max.
Load Current and Max. Current Duration SubMenus;
(27) Enter the relay off voltage in the Relay Off Voltage
SubMenu;
(28) Enter the relay hysteresis value in the Relay Hysteresis
SubMenu;
(29) Exit the RELAY SubMenu;
(30) If required, set up the logging options in the LOGGING
SubMenu.
Full Speed (12Mbps) USB 2.0
The firmware implements a USB 2.0 full speed bulk
Fig.8: this Window appears when the meter is connected to
a PC for the first time, using the USB interface.
82 Silicon Chip
transfer bidirectional endpoint (EP1) with packet size set
to 112 Bytes. This is used to communicate with the host
program on the PC (battcap.exe) through the custom Microchip driver (MCHPUSB).
We explain how to install the driver on Windows OSs
below. Endpoint 0 is implemented as well, as that is mandatory for any USB device.
A transaction between the host program on the PC and
the battery meter consists in sending a 112-Byte packet to
the meter.
The firmware will decode the packet, according to the
sent command, and update itself accordingly.
The meter can also send logging data to the PC. Remember
that the USB driver must be installed correctly for this to
work. Instructions are given below.
Software setup and driver installation
for Windows
The meter’s USB device interface uses the generic Microchip driver for Windows. Before communicating with
the display using the PC host program, you will need to
install this driver.
This section explains how to install the driver in Windows XP, although other versions of Windows will be
similar.
You should have first downloaded the Microchip installer (MCHPFSUSB_Setup_v1.3.exe) from the SILICON
CHIP website and ran it. Note that you must use version
1.3. Older or Newer Versions may not be compatible. This
will (normally) install the driver in the C:\MCHPFUSB\
Pc\MCHPUSB Driver\Release directory.
When you first connect the meter to your computer using a USB cable, Windows will recognize the device as a
“Meter” and a “Microchip Custom USB device”.
The ‘Found New Hardware’ Window appears as shown
in Fig.8 and you should select the “No, not this time”
option and click “Next”. You will be presented with the
next screen as shown in Fig.9. Select “Install from a list or
specific location” and click “Next” again.
The final screen is as shown in Fig.10. Select “Search for
the best driver in these locations” and enable the “Include
this location in the search” box as shown. Now click the
Fig.9: use the “install from a list or specific location”
option to select the correct driver to install.
siliconchip.com.au
“Browse” button. In the “Locate File” window that appears, navigate to where the MCHPUSB files were installed.
Normally it will be C:\MCHPFUSB\Pc\MCHPUSB Driver\
Release. Choose the file “mchpusb.inf”. Select that file, and
then click “Next”.
Windows should install the driver.
If the driver is installed correctly you should be able to see
the meter in device manager (under Control Panel>System
(Hardware Tab)), as shown in Fig.11.
Using the PC host software
To install the PC host program, first download the
compressed file battcap.zip from the SILICON CHIP website
www.siliconchip.com.au (go to the downloads section
under July 2009).
Extract the files in the zipped file to a directory on your
hard drive. There should be these files:
(1) battcap.exe: this is the executable command line
program.
(2) battcap.map: this is an internal file, needed for the
host program to work properly. As long as it is copied to the
same directory as battcap.exe the program will recognise it.
This file is produced by the C compiler of the firmware.
It contains memory mapping information for the firmware
produced by the linker. When and if the firmware is updated, the map file will change.
Using the software
Battcap.exe is a command line program () with three options. The -i option is used to get system settings (‘i’ stands
for information). A screen grab is shown in Fig.12. So you
would type at the command prompt: battcap -i.
The -x option is used to get the current readings which
will update continuously every second or so (a screen grab
is shown in Fig.13).
Finally, the -l option is used for data logging. You will be
asked to confirm whether you wish to transfer the data to
your PC (as this will empty the local buffer). If you choose
‘Yes’, you will be prompted for a file name (it should have
a .csv extension). The default file name will contain the
local time and date.
The data dumped to that file will be in Comma Separated
Fig.10: selecting the path to the driver previously
downloaded from the SILICON CHIP website.
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.11: a view of Device Manager when the driver has been
correctly installed and the meter is connected via the USB.
Values format and can be imported into a spreadsheet. Once
the data is in your spreadsheet you can use its graphing
functions to produce a graph, as shown in Fig.14.
Changing the hardware to suit your
application (advanced)
There are several hardware values which can modified
to suit your application. The sense resistor can be changed
from the default of 10Ω (you should enter the correct value
for your application in the CALIBRATION>Sense Resistance SubMenu).
You can choose to use a different version of the MAX4080
chip for the load or charge sensing if your charging currents are always much smaller than your load currents (to
increase the resolution).
You can then change the value of the gain in the corresponding submenu (hint: they are in the CALIBRATION
SubMenu).
Moreover, you can choose different resistors for the two
voltage dividers as long as you then calibrate them by going
to the CALIBRATION SubMenu.
You can change the current shunt to get a different maximum current range. In this case, you should
both enter the new value of the shunt resistance in the
CALIBRATION>Shunt Resistance SubMenu and then go
to the CALIBRATION>Calibrate Current SubMenu and
follow the prompts.
To turn power on, press S1. To see a particular reading,
press the corresponding key on the keypad, according to
the readings panel shown on p81. For example, to see the
July 2009 83
CALIBRATION SUBMENUS
BATTERY SUBMENUS
DECLARE FULL NOW SubMenu:
Use this menu to declare that the battery
is now full. Press '*' to confirm the
action and '#' to cancel it.
BATTERY CAPACITY SubMenu: enter
the capacity of the battery in AmpHours from 0 to 999999 AH.
CALIBRATE LO DIVIDER SubMenu:
calibrates the low voltage divider. Enter
the voltage at the Low Battery terminal,
pin 5 of the calibration connector.
PEUKERT'S CONSTANT SubMenu: enter
the value of Peukert's constant for your
battery. Allowed input is from 1.0 to 2.0.
Typically 1.1. This only applies to
Lead-Acid batteries.
CALIBRATE HI DIVIDER SubMenu:
calibrates the high voltage divider. Enter
the voltage at the High Battery terminal,
pin 6 of the calibration connector.
CHEMISTRY SubMenu: sets the Chemistry.
Use 'A' and 'B' to change the value and
'#' to finish. Allowed values are Nickel or
Lead-Acid. Note that Nickel includes both
NiMH and NiCad.
SHUNT RESISTANCE SubMenu: sets
the value of the shunt resistance in
milliohms. This value can be further
automatically calibrated by using the
CALIBRATE CURRENT SubMenu below.
EFFICIENCY SubMenu: sets the charging
efficiency of your charger/battery
combination. It is a percentage between
0.1 and 100. Typically 80%.
CALIBRATE CURRENT SubMenu:
calibrate the value of the shunt
resistance automatically. This is calculated from the entered instantanenous
value of the load current.
CYCLE THRESHOLD SubMenu: sets the
cycle detection threshold. It is a
percentage between 10 and 40. Typically
25%. This also clears the cycle count.
LOAD AMP GAIN SubMenu: sets the
value of the load amplifier gain.
Typically, this is 60 for the MAX4080SASA. For the MAX4080TASA it is 20.
CHARGE AMP GAIN SubMenu: sets the
value of the charge amplifier gain.
Typically this is 60 for the MAX4080SASA. It is independent of the load
amplifier.
DISPLAY SUBMENUS
BRIGHTNESS SubMenu: sets the
brightness of the LCD Backlight. Use
the 'A' and 'B' buttons to change and
'#' to set. The value is a percentage
of full brightness.
TIMEOUT SubMenu: sets the backlight
timeout period in seconds.
Typically 15 seconds.
battery voltage you press ‘3’. To enter the menu system,
press ‘#’.
Once in the menu system, use ‘A’ and ‘B’ to move up and
down the menu and the number digits to enter a SubMenu.
To enter numbers, you use the digits, the ‘*’ for the decimal point and the ‘D’ key as backspace.
In all cases you use the ‘#’ to exit the SubMenu and go
back to the previous menu.
From the main menu, press ‘#’ to exit the menu system
and restore the current reading. You should also refer to
the panels which explain the menu system in more detail.
Peukert’s Law and efficiency
For lead-acid batteries, Peukert’s law states that the
change in capacity is not a linear function of the current
drain. Specifically, Peukert’s law states that:
∆C = Ik∆t
where ∆C is the capacity, ∆t is the time, I is the instantaneous current drain and k is a constant higher than 1.0 and
typically between 1.1 and 1.3.
The meter will take into account Peukert’s law when
computing the capacity of the battery. The value of the
constant k will vary for different batteries and you must
set this in the BATTERY>Peukert’s Constant SubMenu.
There is no easy way to compute the correct “k” value
for your system. It is there as a way of adjusting the meter
84 Silicon Chip
SET 5V RAIL SubMenu: calibrates the
ADC system by entering the voltage
of the 5V rail.
SENSE RESISTANCE SubMenu: sets the
value of the sense resistor in Ohms.
Typically this is 10. This can also be
automatically set by using the DETECT
SENSE RESISTANCE SubMenu below.
DETECT SENSE RES. SubMenu:
automatically calibrates the value of the
sense resistor by entering the value of
the instantaneous circuit current.
if you have enough experience with the meter and wish
to tune it.
Cell chemistry and synchronisation
By synchronisation, we mean that when certain conditions are met, the meter sets the capacity to either full or
empty capacity automatically.
You can see at any time when the last synchronisation
occurred by going to the DETECTION>Last Sync. SubMenu.
For example, when the meter detects the end of charge,
it sets the capacity to full capacity. The synchronisation
algorithms are different depending on the cell chemistry.
For Nickel-based batteries, the full capacity synchronisation occurs if the meter detects a trickle charge and
the battery voltage is above the maximum voltage for the
duration of the detection period.
When the battery voltage is detected to be dropping
and is below the minimum voltage (for the duration of the
detection period and is monotonically decreasing at each
detection point) then the battery capacity is synchronised
to zero.
This is because a Nickel battery’s voltage will, once it
has been discharged beyond a point, drop dramatically
and quickly.
For a lead-acid battery, the end of charge is detected if
there is a trickle current and the battery voltage is above
siliconchip.com.au
DETECTION SUBMENUS
SYSTEM SUBMENUS
SHUTDOWN VOLTAGE SubMenu: sets
the voltage below which the meter will shut
down to protect the battery -- eg, 11V for a
SLA Battery.
BEEPER STATUS SubMenu: enables or
disables the beeper function using the
'A' and 'B' buttons. Use the '#' button
to exit.
CAPACITY ALARM SubMenu: sets the
capacity below which the meter will emit
an audible alarm. Use the 'A' and 'B'
buttons to change and '#' to set. Typically
0%. It ranges from -60% to 100%.
AVERAGE SAMPLES SubMenu: sets
the number of samples that will be
averaged for all readings. Typically
this is 30.
STANDBY THRESHOLD SubMenu: sets the
current threshold. When the load and
charge currents are below this, the meter
enters Standby mode. Typically 0.05A.
FIRMWARE VERSION SubMenu: shows
the firmware version. Useful for
debugging or reporting bugs or errors.
TRICKLE CURRENT SubMenu: sets the
trickle current. When the charging current
is below this the meter considers the battery
to be trickle charging. Typically 1/100th of
the AH capacity.
MIN. VOLTAGE SubMenu: sets the
minimum voltage of the battery - eg, for a
SLA this may be typically 11.5V, whereas
for a NiMH battery this could be typically
1.1V per cell.
LAST SYNC. SubMenu: shows the time
elapsed since the last time the battery
capacity was synchronised. A value of
N/A indicates the capacity has not been
recently synchronised.
MAX. VOLTAGE SubMenu: sets the
maximum voltage of the battery - eg, for a
SLA this may be typically 13.8V, whereas
for a NiMH battery this could be typically
1.2V per cell.
LAST LOG SAMPLE SubMenu: shows
how much time has elapsed since the
last log sample was captured.
DETECTION PERIOD SubMenu: sets the
detection period in seconds for
synchronising the battery capacity.
Typically 30 seconds.
DETECTION POINTS SubMenu: sets the
number of intervals in the detection period.
Used only for Nickel batteries.
Typically 4 points.
LAST SYNC. SubMenu: shows the time
elapsed since the last time the battery
capacity was synchronised. A value of N/A
indicates the capacity has not been recently
synchronised.
DETECTION SUBMENU
the maximum voltage for the duration of the detection
period. In this case, the battery capacity is again set to full
capacity.
Note that there is no empty capacity synchronisation for
Lead Acid batteries. However, you should note that Lead
Acid batteries should never be discharged beyond a certain
point or they will be damaged.
Set the detection period by going to the DETECTION
>Detection Period SubMenu. A typical value here is 30
seconds.
You should also set the number of detection points (only
relevant for Nickel batteries). This is set at 4 by default.
The trickle current threshold can be set by going to the
DETECTION>Trickle Current SubMenu. This is typically
C/100 or so of the full battery capacity. So for a 20Ah battery this would be close to 200mA. It really depends on
your charger, however.
Set the Standby current (the current below which the meter
will go into standby), by going to the DETECTION>Standby
Current SubMenu. A typical value will be 50mA.
The meter considers any current higher than the standby
current and lower than the trickle threshold to be a trickle
current for the purpose of synchronisation.
Low capacity alarm
An alarm will be heard when the capacity of the mesiliconchip.com.au
USB CONNECTED SubMenu: indicates
whether the meter is connected to a PC
via the USB. The number in brackets is
the state of the USB enumeration - eg
0=DETACHED, 6=CONFIGURED.
TOTAL LOG TIME SubMenu: shows
how much time has been logged in total.
It indicates that this period of time has
been logged.
RESTORE DEFAULTS SubMenu: restores
default values for most settings. Note
that hardware-dependent settings such
as the sense resistance aren't changed.
TURN METER OFF SubMenu: turns the
meter off. Note that USB power must
be absent for this. The meter will turn
off if the choice is confirmed by pressing
'*'.
SYSTEM SUBMENU
ter falls below the set level (as a percentage). Go to the
DETECTION>Capacity Alarm SubMenu to set the minimum capacity.
The minimum capacity ranges from –60% to 100%. The
capacity of the battery will go negative if it is discharged
beyond the zero point.
If you wish, you can disable the audible beeping by going to the SYSTEM>Beeper Status SubMenu and setting
it to OFF.
Overload and under-voltage protection
An optional external relay can be connected to switch
the load on and off. The charger can be left connected at
all times, however, as shown in Fig.4 last month.
The relay energises to connect the load to the load terminal of the shunt, so the shunt terminal can connect to
the relay common and the load can connect to the relay’s
NO (normally open) terminal.
Once the relay is installed, the microcontroller will
control it.
If you decide to use a relay, make sure it is able to switch
the required current.
For an 80A system we recommend a 150A relay (eg,
Jaycar SY-4073). If you are using lower currents there are
several 60A automotive relays available, eg, Jaycar SY-4074
or Altronics S-4339.
July 2009 85
LOGGING SUBMENUS
RELAY SUBMENUS
LOGGING ERROR SubMenu: sets the
relative percentage error for logging RLE
compression. The lower the error, the
more resolution the data will exhibit.
Typically 20%.
RELAY SYSTEM SubMenu: enables or
disables the relay system using buttons 'A'
and 'B'. Use '#' to exit. When the relay
system is off, the relay remains off. Turn
off if you are not using an external relay.
MIN. ABSOLUTE ERROR SubMenu: sets
the minimum absolute error for logging
RLE compression. The lower the error
the more resolution the data will
exhibit. Typically 0.1.
RELAY COIL RESISTANCE SubMenu: sets
the resistance of the coil of the external
relay (optional). If you are using a dropping
resistor in series with the coil, enter the
total (ie, sum) of the coil & resistor. If you
are not using a relay, disable it in the
RELAY SYSTEM SubMenu below.
SAMPLE PERIOD SubMenu: sets the
sampling period in seconds. Samples are
taken at a frequency equal to the
reciprocal of this period. The range
is from 200ms-1day.
RELAY OFF VOLTAGE SubMenu: sets the
voltage below which the relay switches off.
Typically this is slightly higher than the
minimum battery voltage.
Ch. 1 LOGS SubMenu: sets what reading
channel 1 logs. Use the buttons 'A' or 'B'
to change and '#' to set. Here channel 1
is disabled.
RELAY HYSTERESIS SubMenu: sets the
voltage hysteresis added to the cut-off
voltage. The relay will switch back on when
the voltage exceeds this sum.
Ch. 2 LOGS SubMenu: sets what reading
channel 2 logs. Use the buttons 'A' or 'B'
to change and '#' to set. Here it is set to
log the battery voltage.
MAX. LOAD CURRENT SubMenu: sets the
maximum load current for overload
protection. If the load current exceeds this
current for the duration set below, the relay
switches off. A soft-fuse then trips. It is
reset by pressing S1.
Ch. 3 LOGS SubMenu: sets what reading
channel 3 logs. Use the buttons 'A' or 'B'
to change and '#' to set. Here it is set to
log the capacity percentage of full charge.
MAX. CURRENT DURATION SubMenu: sets
the maximum load current duration in
seconds. The relay will switch off if the load
current exceeds the max load current
setting above for this time.
Ch. 4 LOGS SubMenu: sets what reading
channel 4 logs. Use the buttons 'A' or 'B'
to change and '#' to set. Here it is set to
log the charging current.
OVERLOAD FUSE STATUS SubMenu:
shows the state of the overload fuse. The
fuse trips if there is an overcurrent
condition. The only way to reset the fuse is
to press S1. 'Short' means that the fuse
allows current, 'Open' that it has blown.
LOG MODE SubMenu: sets either
CAPTURE mode (Cpt.) or OVERWRITE
mode (Ovr.) for the RLE Buffer. Use the
buttons 'A' or 'B' to change and '#' to set.
RLE BUFFER POSITION SubMenu:
shows the state of the RLE Buffer. The
brackets indicate the start and end of the
buffer and its position. The number of
bytes in the buffer is also shown.
RELAY SUBMENU
This panel and the ones on previous pages show the various
SubMenus – Detection, System, Logging, Relay, Battery,
Display, Calibration – in more detail and how to access their
parameters. Each of the submenus has a number of options
and these are displayed in the LCD readout as you step
through.
LOGGING SUBMENU
Note that these relays run from 12V.
If your battery system is higher than
12V, a dropping resistor (in series
with the relay coil) will be needed. Its
value is calculated using Ohm’s law,
taking into account the coil resistance
of the relay.
For example, if your relay coil resistance is 180Ω and yours is a 24V
system, a 180Ω 5W resistor would
be used. Similarly, for a 48V system
you would need a 560Ω 5W resistor
(actually 540Ω but 560Ω is the closest
standard value).
A 1N4004 (or similar) diode must
be connected across the relay coil to
quench any back-EMF when the relay
switches off. See Fig.4 from last month.
Enter the value of the coil (or coil and
series resistor) in the RELAY>Relay
Where to get the parts . . .
At least one supplier will be making a kit available for the Smart Battery Capacity Meter. It is possible there will be others but Altronics have indicated that their
stores and mail/web order will have a kit soon (Cat K1700) for $175.00 – see
www.altronics.com.au
If you wish to put together your own kit, then most parts are commonly available and
you should have no problem obtaining them. One exception is the PC board which (as
with all SILICON CHIP boards) is available in from RCS Radio, 41 Arlewis St, Chester Hill
NSW 2162. Phone (02) 9738 0330.
The only other component you may have problems obtaining is the programmed
PIC18F2550-I/SP microcontroller. This is available direct from SILICON CHIP for $25.00
including P&P.
86 Silicon Chip
Coil Resistance SubMenu, as well as
enabling the Relay System by going to
the RELAY>Relay System SubMenu.
On an under-voltage condition the
relay will turn off, switching off the
load and thereby saving the battery
from possible (and irreparable) damage.
Note that the relay “off” voltage is
usually slightly higher than the shut
down voltage (the latter, typically,
should not ever be reached and is only
a fail-safe measure as detailed shortly).
The relay will only turn back on
when the battery voltage rises above
the sum of the relay off voltage and
the relay hysteresis (both measured
in Volts). This adds a measure of hysteresis avoiding ‘hunting’. The trip
point and hysteresis are set by going
to the RELAY>Relay Off Voltage &
RELAY>Relay Hysteresis SubMenus.
For an over-current condition, you
set the maximum current and its duration before the relay switches off and
trips a software fuse.
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.14: this screen grab is from the Microsoft Excel spreadsheet program. We have imported the CSV file obtained by
running the command “battcap.exe -l” and graphed the battery voltage as a function of time.
The relay (and hence the load) will
remain off indefinitely after the fuse
trips.
The only way to reset this software
fuse is to press S1. The battery voltage
should bounce back up once the load
is disconnected.
Note that the relay will only turn
back on once the voltage is above the
sum of the relay off voltage and the
hysteresis voltage.
The relay system should be switched
off (RELAY>Relay System) if not used.
Fail-safe shutdown
When the voltage of the battery
drops below the level set in the
DETECTION>ShutDown Voltage
SubMenu, the circuit (as well as the
relay) will turn off.
This is a fail-safe measure and in
normal operation should never occur.
It is there to protect the battery in the
last resort. After power is lost, the
meter is turned on again by pressing
S1. If the voltage is still too low, the
meter will again shut down but not
before you have a chance to access the
menu system by pressing ‘#’.
This allows you to change any settings if needs be, before the meter shuts
down (so you are never ‘locked out’
completely).
into VIDEO/TV/RF?
Television & Video
Technology – by KF Ibrahim
New edition has a full and
compre-hensive guide to
video and TV tech-nology
including HDTV and DVD,
$
58 starting with fundamentals.
$
70
NEW LOW PRICE!
DVD Players and Drives
$
95
NEW LOW PRICE!
$
85
– by KF Ibrahim
DVD technology and applications - ideal for engineers,
technicians, students,
installation and sales staff.
Practical Guide To
Satellite TV – by Garry Cratt
The book written by an Aussie for
Aussie conditions. Everything you
need to know – including
what you cannot do! 7th ed.
$
49
Hands-On Zigbee – by Fred Eady
$
9650
NEW LOW PRICE!
$
75
An in-depth look at the
clever little 2.4GHz wireless
chip that’s starting to be
found in a wide range of
equipment from
consumer to industrial.
$
There’s something to suit every
RF fan in the SILICON CHIP
reference bookshop: see the
bookshop pages in this issue
75
RF Circuit Design
– by Chris Bowick
A new edition of this classic RF
NEW LOW PRICE!design text - tells how to design
and integrate RF components
$
74 into virtually any circuitry.
Practical RF H’book
– by Ian Hickman
A reference work for technic90 ians, engineers, students and
NEW LOW PRICE! the more specialised enthusiast. Covers all the key topics in
$
73 RF that you need to understand.
$
! Audio ! RF ! Digital ! Analog ! TV ! Video ! Power Control ! Motors ! Robots ! Drives ! Op Amps ! Satellite
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 87
Note that when the meter has lost
power and starts again, the capacity
reading will revert to 50% and may
not be accurate until the next synchronisation, or until you manually
declare the battery at full capacity by
going to the BATTERY>Declare Full
Now SubMenu.
RLE compression
Fig. 12: a screen grab showing the result of running the command “battcap.exe
-i” to get information on the current settings.
RLE (Run Length Encoding) Compression is used for data logging using
an internal buffer.
Run-length encoding works by
substituting a consecutive run of
similar readings by a single reading
and a multiplicity. For example, the
sequence 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0 would
be encoded as (1.0, 5) to save space.
Depending on the set RLE Relative
Error and the RLE Absolute Error, the
compression is lossy or lossless.
It is lossless if both the errors are
set to 0. If not, the compression will
be lossy and can achieve a good compression ratio.
For example, if the relative error is
set to 5%, the readings 1.0, 1.02, 1.03,
0.98, 0.99 will be encoded as (1.0, 5)
since each is within ±5% of the first
reading. This can save a lot of space
in the local buffer allowing you to log
a greater period of time. The trade off
is of course accuracy.
RLE is simple to implement and
ideally suited to this type of logging
application, where the readings are
changing slowly over time.
You can log up to four different
readings at any time and each reading
can be one of the following: battery
Voltage, time remaining or charging,
load current, charge current, circuit
current, relay current, net current,
capacity (AH) or capacity (%).
To set up logging, you go to the LOGGING SubMenu. The logging data is
stored locally and can be downloaded
to a PC using the USB interface.
Over time, this can become a useful
set of data in monitoring the state of
batteries to allow you to not only get
peak performance but longest life.
Conclusion
Fig.13: this shows the result of running the command line “battcap.exe -x” – the
real-time readings are displayed every second.
88 Silicon Chip
As you can see, the SILICON CHIP
Battery Capacity Meter has comprehensive features that will allow you
to monitor the health of your battery
and charger system.
It is not difficult to build and can
be easily calibrated using a digital
SC
multimeter (DMM).
siliconchip.com.au
Vintage Radio
By RODNEY CHAMPNESS, VK3UG
The Lyric 8-Valve Console
From The 1920s
This view shows the rear of the chassis, with the valve cover for the RF
stages removed. All the valves were still in working order.
Featuring no less than eight valves, the
Lyric Model 70 broadcast-band receiver
is an upmarket American-made set from
the late 1920s. It’s a tuned RF design
with single-knob tuning and a number of
interesting design techniques.
E
XPERIMENTERS in the early days
of radio produced some very ordinary looking receivers, mainly because
they were forever changing things to
improve the performance of their sets.
Sometimes they were successful but
mostly they just thought their set was
definitely superior to their mate’s set.
Those early sets were built on wooden boards and these were commonly
referred to as “breadboards”. In fact,
some were built on a real breadboards,
siliconchip.com.au
pirated from the kitchen!
The breadboard-style layout was a
very convenient method of construction during the early days of radio,
as it made it very easy to continually
change a set’s circuit or layout. As a
result, experimenters’ sets used this
style of construction for many years
and even today the term “breadboarding” is used when building makeshift
circuits.
Breadboarding led directly to the
so-called “coffin style” radios when
companies began manufacturing domestic receivers in the early 1920s.
In reality, these were breadboard sets
with a nice wooden cabinet built
around them, with a hinged lid on
top that allowed ready access to the
set’s internals. This also made it easy
to occasionally tweak the circuit for
better performance.
Receivers in the 1920s were attractive pieces of lounge-room furniture
and that certainly applied to many
coffin-style receivers. However, as the
1920s progressed, most manufacturers
quickly developed new methods for
constructing their receivers. For a start,
the top-of-the-line receivers needed to
be more elegant in appearance. They
also had to perform better and be easier
to operate than the early 1920s sets.
In particular, those early receivers
commonly used several single-gang
tuning capacitors, a regeneration
control and a filament control (for
volume), which made them difficult
to tune and adjust. What was wanted
by the average user was a receiver with
just one tuning control and a volume
control that had no time delay (as occurred with filament rheostats). They
also wanted sets that didn’t whistle
when the volume was increased above
a certain level and they also needed
to be more sensitive than the earlier
1920s models.
In short, ease of use was the aim and
people were prepared to pay more for
sets that met that aim.
Breadboard-style construction had
reached its zenith during the 1920s. It
was not easy to build relatively highgain receivers with multiple radio
frequency (RF) stages without shielding between the stages. What’s more,
these stages had to be close together in
the later sets because people wanted
single-knob tuning.
Initially, single-knob tuning was
achieved by mechanically coupling
single-gang tuning capacitors via
metal bands. These were then coupled
July 2009 89
The unit features a 4-gang tuning
capacitor, a large drum-type dial
and a plug-in capacitor box.
to a single tuning control. However,
with the advent of multi-gang tuning
capacitors, shielding became critical.
To overcome this problem, manufacturers hit on the idea of using a
metal chassis – basically a “cake tin”
turned upside down. A metal chassis
had several advantages over the traditional breadboard: (1) it was possible
to produce a layout that worked well
with no feedback; (2) the shields for the
RF coils were effectively earthed to the
chassis, which made them more effective; (3) cut-outs in the chassis could
be standardised so that assembly was
easier to manufacture (and therefore
less costly); and (4) more components
could be used as they could be fitted
both above and below the chassis
while still retaining accessibility.
The downside was that many servicemen initially didn’t like the idea
of working on both sides of the chassis because the concept was foreign
to them. The same sort of attitude
initially greeted PC boards during
the 1960s.
The Lyric Model 70
The Wurlitzer Company made
many magnificent organs over many
years but what is not so well known
is that the company also dabbled in
radio manufacture during the 1920s
and early 1930s. In particular, the radios were made by the All-American
Mohawk Corporation which
Wurlitzer controlled.
Once such unit was the Lyric
Model 70, which is a very interesting set from the 1920s era. The unit
featured here is owned by Mark and
has been overhauled by Marcus, both
fellow enthusiasts in our local vintage
radio club. In fact, the chassis was
Above: the dial has both wavelength and kilocycle
markings, while the Tuning and Volume controls
are mounted directly beneath the dial escutcheon.
The toggle switch in the centre is the On/Off control.
Left: the iron-cored chokes, the speaker transformer
and the electrodynamic speaker are all attached to
each other to form a single assembly. This assembly
is connected via a cable and plug to the chassis.
90 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Another view from the rear of the chassis, this
time with the perforated valve steel cover (for the
RF valves) in place. The boxes at the back house
the interstage audio transformers.
regularly brought to club meetings as
the restoration progressed, to discuss
any problems that had occurred along
the way.
The set was originally imported
from America and has been operating
via a 240V to 110V isolation transformer for most of its life. In fact, the
person who originally owned it must
have been quite wealthy, as a set of this
calibre was a top-shelf model in its day.
The set has also obviously been
well looked after because its cabinet
is still in very good condition. It was
initially cleaned and then the inside
brushed out with linseed oil thinned
with mineral turps. A commercial
furniture restorer was then applied to
the outside using a soft rag.
The views from both the front and
back show that the manufacturer took
pride in the appearance of this set. The
dial escutcheon is of similar style to
the better sets of the era and has both
wavelength and kilocycle markings.
The ornate Tuning and Volume control
knobs are mounted directly under the
escutcheon, while the toggle switch in
the centre is the On/Off control.
The cabinet is solid and the finish
on the timber is good, with no short
siliconchip.com.au
cuts in the making of this cabinet. It is
definitely a 2-man job to shift, as the
cabinet and chassis combined are quite
heavy. In fact the speaker assembly
and the chassis weigh in at 6kg and
12.5kg respectively, which the cabinet
adding to that.
Circuit details
The Lyric Model 70 is an 8-valve
TRF (tuned radio frequency) receiver,
designed to be powered from 110V AC.
It has a number of features that were
quite cutting edge for the era plus a few
other features that, while interesting
innovations, were really not practical
in the long term.
Fig.1 shows the circuit details. As
can be seen, the antenna connects
to the primary of the first RF tuned
circuit. It also connects to a 12kΩ
rheostat (R9) that gradually shorts out
the antenna as it is rotated and forms
part of the volume control network.
Following the antenna, the signal is
fed to the first tuned circuit where it is
amplified by a 226 triode. The resulting signal on the plate of this valve is
then fed via a second tuned circuit to
another 226 triode where it is further
amplified. A third tuned circuit and
RF amplifier stage, again based on a
226 triode, follow.
From there, the signal is fed via a
fourth tuned circuit to a 227 triode
detector stage. This has an audio transformer connected to its plate circuit
(approximate step up ratio: 1:3) and
the secondary of this is connected to a
second 227 audio stage. The output of
this stage is then fed through another
audio step-up transformer to the grid
of a 250 audio output stage.
Finally, the audio output stage drives
the loudspeaker via a speaker transformer.
Interesting points
There are a number of interesting
features in the RF amplifier stages.
First, each RF triode stage is neutralised using neutralisation capacitors
that are mounted on the 4-gang tuning capacitor – see photo. These are
adjusted during manufacture (via
three screws along the bottom edge)
so that the receiver is stable under all
conditions with the volume control
set at maximum.
Another unusual feature of the
4-gang tuning capacitor is the method
used to achieve tracking across the
July 2009 91
Fig.1: the circuit features three tuned RF stages based on
226 triode valves. The amplified RF signal is then fed to a
227 detector stage, after which the audio passes through
a second 227 stage and then via a transformer to the grid
of a 250 audio output stage. A 280 valve functions as the
rectifier, while the remaining 226 triode provides the bias
for the 250 audio output stage.
cuits to track would have been quite
a task and certainly not one for the
faint-hearted to attempt.
As mentioned above, rheostat R9
progressively shorts the antenna signal
and functions as the volume control.
This control also has a second section
which is connected to capacitor C2 in
the plate circuit of the first RF stage.
In operation, R9 and C2 progressively
detune and partially short out the signal in the plate circuit to increase the
effectiveness of the volume control.
Another interesting feature is the
filament supply arrangement. The
first three stages have their filaments
fed from a 1.5V line and they have a
centre-tap resistor (R2) wired across
the filament line. This was known as
a “humdinger” and its function was to
reduce any hum that may be induced
from the filaments into the signal path.
A resistor from the centre tap of this
“humdinger” to the chassis provides
bias for these stages.
The detector and the first audio
stage also have a “humdinger” (R4)
across their 2.5V heater line to null
out hum that could affect the audio
signal. These are the only two indirectly heated valves in the receiver.
The centre tap of this “humdinger”
goes to the same bias resistor used for
the 226 valves.
The audio output stage uses the
rather large 250 valve. It is fed from
its own 7.4V filament line, and once
again it has a “humdinger” across the
filament line to chassis. The 250 is a
low-gain valve with a gain of less than
four. It also requires quite a high bias
voltage, which can be as high as -84V.
However, in this receiver a bias of only
-52V to -56V is required.
The bias for this stage is derived
from a separate bias supply. This
consists of a separate winding on the
power transformer which is connected
to a 226 valve wired as a diode, with
a 0.5µF filter capacitor. This filtered
is then fed through a resistive divider
and the secondary of the driver transformer to the grid of the 250.
HT supply
broadcast band. As shown in the
photo, there are another six adjustment screws positioned on the edge
of the frame, three between the four
gangs at the front and three more at
the back. These screws are adjusted
92 Silicon Chip
to shift a plate between each gang section, to alter the capacitance between
the fixed plates and earth so that the
tuned circuits could be adjusted to
track correctly. There are no cores in
any of the RF coils, so getting the cir-
The HT supply is conventional with
a full-wave 280 rectifier supplying the
HT to all stages of the receiver. The line
is filtered by two 13-Henry iron-cored
filter chokes plus five capacitors.
This receiver was built before electrolytic capacitors were available, so
large paper capacitors of 2µF and 3µF
siliconchip.com.au
This under-chassis view shows the unit after restoration had been completed. The various plug-in modules have both
advantages and disadvantages when it comes to servicing.
were used instead. However, from
the circuit, it’s apparent that the 280
rectifier is running close to its limits,
with around 400V on the filament on
load and a total HT current drain of
around 70-80mA.
Record player input
The receiver has provision for a
record player input but it’s doubtful
that it would work. As shown on the
circuit, the audio from the record
player appears to be connected across
the secondary winding of the RF tuned
circuit feeding the detector. As a result,
the audio signal would be effectively
shorted out by this RF coil winding.
Finally, the valve types used lost
their prefix around 1930 and became
known simply as the 26, 27, 50 & 80.
Plug-in modules
As shown in one of the photos,
the iron-cored chokes, the speaker
transformer and the electrodynamic
speaker are attached to each other to
form a single assembly. This assembly
is connected via a cable and plug to
the chassis.
The plug is wired so that when it is
disconnected, the power is automatically disconnected from the primary of
siliconchip.com.au
The 4-way tuning gang carries three variable capacitors along the bottom edge
and these are used to neutralise each of the RF stages. In addition, there are six
adjustment screws between the four gangs (three at the front and three at the
back) and these are adjusted to ensure correct tracking across the band.
the power transformer. This prevents
the power supply from generating
excessive voltage on the output of
the rectifier when the assembly is unplugged. It also helps to protect a careless serviceman from electrocution.
However, C11 is part of this assembly
and is normally connected directly to
the output of the rectifier. As a result, it
would stay charged and could deliver
a lethal shock if touched.
The next plug-in module is the capacitor bank, consisting of 10 capacitors housed in a metal box (see photo).
This was designed to be replaced as a
single unit, meaning that if one became
faulty the whole lot had to be replaced.
This would have been expensive and
July 2009 93
The chassis sits on a horizontal shelf in the top half of the cabinet, while the
loudspeaker assembly is mounted in the bottom half and is connected via a
cable and plug. Note the 240V to 110V step-down transformer at bottom right.
as a result, plug-in modules like this
didn’t find general favour at that time.
Finally, the power transformer and
the two interstage audio transformers
are also plugged into sockets. Each of
these is then secured to the chassis
using four bolts.
In short, this set had a number of
modules that could easily be replaced
if necessary, making it straightforward
to service.
Restoration
The plug-in capacitor box contained a large
number of faulty paper capacitors, which
meant that a complete new assembly had to
be made up.
94 Silicon Chip
When the set first arrived on Marcus’s bench it was in a remarkably
good condition considering its age.
The cabinet and chassis only required
a dust-out to make it easy to work on.
However, he had no circuit diagram
at that stage and this made things difficult. It is a complex set and it’s not
easy to figure out what exactly is inside
the plug-in capacitor and choke boxes.
Despite having no circuit, Marcus
immediately began restoring the set.
His first task was to replace some
poor-quality wiring, a legacy of some
previous servicing. By contrast, the
original wiring was found to be quite
neatly done, even if it wasn’t always
easy to follow.
As mentioned previously, because it
was designed for 110VAC, the set was
powered via a 240V to 110V isolation
transformer (not an autotransfomer).
In the interests of safety, the original
mains wiring was replaced to Australian standards.
Next, the valves were removed and
tested and all were found to be in good
working order. That was fortunate as
replacements would not be cheap
and in any case, would be difficult to
source. The only electrolytic capacitor
in the set, which proved to be a ring-in,
had dried out and was replaced.
A Faraday shield had originally
been fitted over the RF valves but this
was now missing. As a result, a perforated metal shield was made up and
painted the same colour as the chassis
before fitting it into place.
The capacitors were the next on
the list. After examining the chassis,
Marcus concluded that any leaky
capacitors in the capacitor box were
unlikely to cause problems with the
valves, as transformers are used for
the interstage coupling. Further checks
also indicated that there were no shorts
to earth or excess leakage to earth, so it
would be safe to run the set for a short
time in order to check voltages in the
various stages.
Well, it worked but it didn’t work
very well. A heat-sensitive intermittent fault soon became apparent and
there was also a fault with the volume
control.
Fortunately, a circuit diagram became available at about this time and
this made troubleshooting so much
easier, as it revealed the contents of
the two “boxes”.
First, the speaker/filter choke box
was opened up and paper capacitor
C12 across the speaker transformer
primary replaced. All the other components in this box were in good order
but the capacitors in the capacitor box
were a different story.
Removing the capacitors from this
box was a difficult job as they had been
set in pitch. In the end, a heat gun was
used to soften the pitch, after which
a carving knife was used to separate
the capacitor assembly from the case.
In short, it was a time-consuming and
messy job.
As expected, the 10 paper capacitors were all leaky and so had to be
replaced. This was done by mounting
much smaller replacement capacitors
on two pieces of fibreboard (see photo).
In particular, the 2µF and 3µF capacitors were replaced with mains-rated
motor-start capacitors and the rest
siliconchip.com.au
ventional pots and is basically a dual
rheostat rather than a potentiometer.
It only has one gang but two separate
tracks, which in this circuit are earthed
via the wiper.
The markings on the control, although appearing to relate to the resistance of the sections, are probably
type numbers. It all confused Marcus
before he obtained the circuit which
revealed that each track has a resistance of 12kΩ. The unit was replaced
with a dual-gang 10kΩ potentiometer.
Finally, all the resistors were check
ed and five out-of-tolerance component replaced.
Testing
The new capacitor bank was made up by mounting the parts on a couple of
pieces of fibreboard and connecting them via flying leads. This assembly was
then housed in the original box. The original capacitor bank is visible at top left.
with mains-rated MKT and polyester
types. The value of each capacitor was
marked next to it on the fibreboard, to
aid future servicing.
As shown in the photo, the various
leads were then soldered to the appropriate pins on the capacitor box plug,
after which the box was plugged back
into the set.
By the way, the two capacitors marked C12 are used to tune the filter chokes
for maximum filtering effect. However,
the originals were meant to resonate
on 120Hz ripple, not the 100Hz ripple
with Australian mains. As a result, it
was unnecessary to increase the values
of the two C12 capacitors to achieve
resonance in the filter network. The
mica capacitors were tested and found
to be in good order.
Tracking down the intermittent
It was now time to find the thermally-sensitive intermittent fault. The
volume of the set would vary at a slow
rate, indicating a problem with either a
valve filament, a socket or some other
part of the filament supply line.
Careful testing revealed that the
filament voltage on the lines to the
226 valves was varying and was low
at around 0.9V AC. This problem
was traced to the two “humdinger”
centre-tap resistors on the filament
lines to the 226s and 227s. These had
riveted terminals which were making
poor contact. They were cleaned and
then soldered so that there was no
discontinuity between the rivets and
the riveted metalwork.
When this was done, the filament
voltage to the 226s was restored to
the correct 1.5V AC. This markedly
improved the set’s performance and
it was now obvious that it would be
worthwhile spending the money to
get the speaker re-coned. This was
subsequently done and it now has a
high-quality foam-suspension cone
which complements the quality of the
rest of the receiver.
The defective volume control was
the next item on the list. This item is
quite different in construction to con-
It was now time to see what the
receiver was capable of. There was no
apparent instability in the RF sections
so the neutralisation adjustments were
left alone. The tuning coils and tracking adjustments were also left as they
were, as the performance was very
good and no adjustments were deemed
necessary. The bias on the 250 audio
output triode was checked and found
to be in the design range of -52-56V.
In operation, the receiver proved to
have quite good selectivity and each
station appeared in only one spot on
the dial. It certainly had no trouble
selecting stations that were relatively
close in frequency to the local broadcasting stations.
In summary, its performance is quite
good for a set of its age and style and
it would have been the focal point of
any lounge-room it graced during the
late 1920s and early 1930s. However,
it would have become obsolete, at least
in a design sense, by around 1935 due
to rapid advances in technology and
the increasing popularity of superhet
receivers.
That said, it still would have been
a great set to have in the home and
even today its performance is quite
credible. It’s a set well-worth having
in a collection, particularly as it is in
SC
such good working condition.
Issues Getting Dog-Eared?
Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP safe with these
handy binders
REAL
VALUE
AT
$14.95
PLUS P
&
P
Available Aust, only. Price: $A14.95 plus $10.00 p&p per order (includes GST).
Just fill in and mail the handy order form in this issue; or fax (02) 9939 2648; or
call (02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number.
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 95
ASK SILICON CHIP
Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line
and we’ll answer your question. Write to: Ask Silicon Chip, PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097 or
send an email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Faulty LED indication
in Speed Alert
I built the Speed Alert project as
published in the November and December 1999 issues of SILICON CHIP.
The kit was a dream to build and functions well except that LED1 (visual
alarm) stays on permanently.
I have checked all solder joints etc
and cannot find any faults. It seems
that there is ground potential on pin
6 of the PIC all the time. The audible
alarm works every 10s (as it should)
but is quite faint. (R. B., via email).
• The alarm LED (LED1) is driven via
the 5V dimmed supply at the emitter
of Q4 through the 560Ω resistor and to
pin 2 of IC1. If pin 2 is low then LED1
will light.
Normally pin 2 is at 5V unless the
alarm is on. The only way LED1 could
be alight continuously is if there is
a short to ground for pin 2 (or a low
resistance to ground). Alternatively,
check that LED1 is oriented correctly.
9V to 27V DC
converter wanted
I am interested in your DC-DC Converter, as published in the June 2003
issue. Its maximum output is 20V.
My requirement is for a DC-DC
converter which has a 9V input and
a 27V output. Do you have a suitable
circuit? (R. R., Rowville, Vic).
• The DC-DC Converter can be altered
to deliver 27V by changing the 1.2kΩ
resistor in series with trimpot VR1 to
470Ω. Note that the output current
would be limited to about 450mA.
Help with old EA
ignition circuit
I have been using a design for a
transistor ignition published in EA in
February 1983. It has been installed
on numerous vehicles and recently
on a 1985 model Toyota Hilux. This
circuit has been extremely reliable and
has given no problems in the vehicles
it has run. Recently, I had the main
switching transistor fail (short circuit).
Looking at the alternatives you have
published over the years led me back to
my original one as being easier to fix.
But can I replace the BUX80, 2N6547
transistor originally used with one of
the newer MJ10012 or MJH10012 Darlington transistors without any mods
to the original circuit? If not, can you
suggest any modifications to make it
work? (C. L., via email).
• The MJ10012 or MJH10012 can be
used to replace the BUX80 but the old
“Electronics Australia” Transistor Assisted Ignition circuit is not ideal for
the MJ(H)1012 transistor as it draws
Power Supply For Multimedia PC Amplifier
I built the Multimedia PC Amplifier and Speakers (SILICON CHIP, October & November 1996) some years
ago for use on an old 486 computer
with ISA sockets. Recently I found
a use for it again, using the line input from a set-top box and volume
control via the STB remote in a TV
set-up using a spare monitor I have.
The set-up works well but the old
486 computer is noisy and really all I
need is an appropriate power unit for
the 12-0-12V supply and a suitable
enclosure. I note the computer 12V
96 Silicon Chip
supply is 6A and 0.6A – and my son
has advised me that there is a much
larger current required on the positive rail of the amplifier. Apart from
using the computer, have you any
suggestions as to a suitable power
supply. (G. C., via email).
• Your son is correct. The positive
12V supply rail will need to supply
more than 4A peak when the amplifiers are running at full power. A
computer power supply is still the
best answer. These days they tend
to be a lot quieter.
more current than is necessary to drive
the latter Darlington transistor.
The 10Ω resistor at transistor Q4’s
base should be a 1W type due to the
higher voltage drop from base to emitter for the Darlington MJ(H)10012.
Two of the 2.7Ω resistors driving Q4’s
base could be removed since there is
no need for the high base current with
the Darlington.
Concern over Nixie
tubes in digital clock
I refer to the Retro Nixie Clock in the
July & August 2007 issues of SILICON
CHIP. With the clock running permanently, what would be the predicted
life of the Nixie tubes? Do they, after
a period of time, simply “give up the
ghost”? Would the clock’s “normal”
life be 3, 4 or 10 years? (K. J., via email).
• The life of a Nixie tube depends on
the manufacturing quality, the way the
tube is driven and the care with which
they are handled. There is no definitive
answer as to their life.
We expect a good Nixie tube to last
many years in the digital clock. We
cannot give a precise estimate. If you
are concerned, it would be wise to get
some spares before the availability of
these becomes scarce.
Sourcing coils
for the Theremin
I have read the article on the Theremin (SILICON CHIP, August 2000) and
I need information to get the variable
coils. I have visited the websites for
Mitsumi and Toko but I cannot select
suitable coils for the Theremin. Can
you help? (C. T., Santiago, Chile).
• Mitsumi or Toko do not make the
specified coils. You can obtain the correct coils from Jaycar Electronics (Cat.
LF-1050). You would require three (3)
of the LF-1050 coil packs to get the
correct number of white-slugged cores.
Contact www.jaycar.com.au
Note that a revised version of this
Theremin circuit was published in
the March 2009 issue of SILICON CHIP.
siliconchip.com.au
External DAC For A CD Or DVD Player
I cannot find any reference to
DACs (Digital-to-Analog Converters)
as used for hifi CD data conversion.
These are available from hifi dealers
but it’s a project that SILICON CHIP
could consider. I have already built
several hifi-based projects published
by SILICON CHIP and a top-quality
DAC would be great.
Do you have any plans for such a
project? (R. P, Horley, UK).
• As we see it, there are only two
reasons why you would use a separate DAC with an existing CD player:
(1) the existing DAC in your CD
player is audibly inferior or (2) you
want to avoid any problems with
hum induction or earth loops by
using the digital output of your CD
player.
How to make
front panels
Have you ever described the process
and materials used to produce the
front panel labels of your projects.
Alternatively, is there a website that
you can point me to for information
on the process that you use? (R. S.,
Burrill Lake, NSW).
• We have published several articles
on making front panels:
(1) Making Front Panels For Your
Projects (February 1999);
(2) At Last – An Easy Way To Make
Pro Panels (April 2002);
(3) Restoring Old Dials, Front Panels
And Labels (July 2004); and
(4) Making Panels For Projects (July
2007).
Incidentally, by far the easiest way to
make a high-quality front panel these
days is to produce it using any of the
PC drawing/graphics packages (we
use CorelDraw), print it out on good
quality paper and then laminate it. A4
laminators are now very cheap – we’ve
seen them for as low as $29.95!
No real need to vary
speed control frequency
I have built four of the 12-24V high
current motor controllers for use in
work platforms in temperature-controlled, horticultural tunnel houses.
The units drive a 24V DC motor/
siliconchip.com.au
Neither of these issues are significant for the vast majority of users
and in any case, in spite of all the
subjective rubbish written in UK
hifi magazines, most people would
be unable to hear any difference
between the DAC output of a typical
good-quality CD player from Sony,
Yamaha, Marantz, Denon etc and
any external DAC, no matter how
pricey it may be.
However, if you are using a DVD
player to play your CDs, even a
good-quality brand may be notably
inferior to the abovementioned CD
players. In fact, in our experience, all
DVD players have significant problems when used in conjunction with
a good-quality home hifi system.
This is firstly because they all
gearbox. The units all work well. My
question is why do I need to alter the
frequency? (B. B., via email).
• For most applications there will be
no need to alter the frequency of the
speed control. In fact, for most applications you can leave all the standard
(default) settings unchanged.
However, if you have a motor or
gearbox which is noisy at a particular
frequency, then you have the option
to change. Also, depending on the
motor’s inductance, you may find that
it responds better to a higher or lower
drive frequency.
Running a caravan
from solar power
I have bought a new caravan with a
12V system and in-house battery. I use
an electric razor and when on 12VDC
will use a 12V-to-230V AC inverter.
I also thought the inverter would
come in handy for charging a video
camera and a still camera battery.
The two chargers involved are both
switchmode units and I have been told
that this type of charger should only be
connected to a sinewave supply; never
to a modified square wave supply. Do
you have any thoughts on this?
I have a 50W solar cell which has
an output of a little over 3A, which I
would like to use (if off mains supply)
to top up the battery (a 95A.h deepcycle type). Do I really need a charge
use double-insulated switchmode
power supplies. These can inject
significant hum into a hifi system
as well as high-frequency frizzle, in
some cases.
Secondly, the DAC and audio
output stages used in the majority of
DVD players typically give inferior
or even poor audio quality.
Ultimately, an external DAC with
SPDIF or TOSLINK connection is the
way to go if you want hifi audio from
a DVD player. In fact, the TOSLINK
connection is the best because it
eliminates all problems with hum
induction or hum loops.
With this in mind, we plan to
publish a high-quality DAC with
SPDIF and TOSLINK inputs, starting
with the August or September issue.
controller on a system as small as
this? If so, why? I don’t think it would
overcharge the battery at a maximum
of 3A, do you? Has SILICON CHIP ever
published a construction article for a
charge controller? If so, would you tell
me which edition it was in?
To lessen the load on the battery, I
have constructed and fitted a number
of LED lights in parallel to the fluorescent/incandescent lights already
fitted, with a total battery drain of
only 1A compared to about 10A! What
with solid-state hard drives and LED
lighting, the electrical and electronics scene sure is changing. (N. W., via
email).
• We doubt whether you would need
a controller. We would be inclined to
just hook it up and then monitor the
battery over a period to see how it goes.
Ozitronics
Tel: (03) 8677 1411 Fax: (03) 9011 6220
Email: sales2009<at>ozitronics.com
4-Channel
Temperature
Monitor and
Controller
Features 4 temperature inputs (DS1820)
and 4 relays for output control. Simple text
commands via RS232 to read temperature
and control relays. Can be controlled by
terminal program or via free Windows application. Pluggable screw terminals for
sensors and relay outputs. K190 $104.50
More kits and all documentation available on website:
www.ozitronics.com
July 2009 97
Misconceptions About Ions In Salt Solution
I was just reading your article
entitled “Test The Salt Content Of
Your Swimming Pool” (SILICON CHIP,
December 2008) and thought about
using your technique at home. I was
investigating further when I found a
couple of articles stating that using
an ohmmeter for testing will cause
a molecular change within the salt
solution due to the test current being
DC, thus making the test invalid. I
include a link to of one of the articles
I read concerning this: http://blea.ch/
wiki/index.php/PPM_Meter
I am now quite confused about
the whole situation. (G. F., Kurralta
Park, SA).
• The quote you are referring to
is as follows: “Because they pass
DC current thru the probes and you
cannot measure conductivity of
salts with DC current because it will
rip the molecules apart, and since
the molecules are what conducts
the electricity you get a constantly
changing reading that is useless.
Overcome this by using an AC signal. If the frequency is high enough
(>1kHz it seems) the molecules don’t
have time to move apart before they
are pulled in the opposite direction.
Sort of like how high DC current
will throw a person off of it, where
as AC forces them to hold on and
get shocked to death or something.”
As with so much stuff on the
internet, this is utter nonsense and
indicative of the high level of ignorance of all things technical by most
people. In fact, when you dissolve
salt into solution, the molecules
of salt become sodium (Na+) and
chloride (Cl-) ions and it is precisely
because of these ions that electric
current can pass through the solution. This is just basic chemistry.
However, the designer of this
PPM circuit is on the right track in
advocating the use of AC rather than
DC to make the measurement. But it
is has nothing to do with “ripping
molecules apart”.
The reason for using AC rather
than DC is to avoid electrolysis of
the measuring electrodes. In effect,
the electrodes would be eaten away
over a long period of time. That is
why commercial TDS/PPM meters
generally use carbon electrodes and
an AC test voltage. If DC was used
If you do want to build a controller
have a look at the December 1999,
March 2002 and February 2008 issues.
We have also published a lot of solarrelated items in Circuit Notebook.
Your chargers should be OK running
from a modified square-wave inverter.
This Australian supplier has various switches available. You would
probably need to set the sensor to
about 5 psi.
Pressure switch wanted
for pool pump circuit
I built the Remote Control Extender
(SILICON CHIP, October 2006) and it
works well with all my TVs & VCRs but
it won’t work on my Panasonic DMRXW300 DVD recorder. I’ve used various IR receivers out of modern VCRs
and it will only work intermittently.
Can you tell me where to source
the TSOP4136 IR receiver? Altronics
and Jaycar don’t know if theirs is a
TSOP4136 (Jaycar ZD-1952). Also Altronics supplied TLC555 for the 7555
timers. Are these OK? (E. L., via email).
• The IR receiver supplied with the
kits from both Jaycar and Altronics
for this project is the TSOP4136. The
Jaycar ZD-1952, however, is not a
TSOP4136 and is not suitable for use
with the extender as it will not work
I have a query regarding the pressure
switch used for the Smart Pool Pump
Control circuit featured in the Circuit
Notebook pages of the October 2008
issue. Would you have any suggestions
as to who would stock them?
Thanks for producing such a highquality magazine every month with
excellent projects and interesting
articles. (P. B., Richmond, NSW).
• Farnell (www.farnell.com.au) sell
pressure sensors (eg, Cat. 723-0461)
but these are expensive. You may
be able to obtain a suitable pressure
sensor from www.baccara.com.au/
pressure-switches.shtml
98 Silicon Chip
Infrared remote
extender query
with carbon electrodes, it would
lead to electrode polarisation and
high resistance readings.
In fact, meters which purport to
measure TDS (total dissolved solids)
are a bit of a joke anyway because
they can only measure those solids
which dissolve to form an ionic
solution. For example, they cannot
measure the amount of sugar in a
solution because sugar does not
break up into ions.
And while the designer stresses
the importance of a nice clean sinewave for the test waveform, that is
not strictly necessary. All you need
is an AC waveform with a 50% duty
cycle and no DC component. In other
words, a square or sawtooth waveform would do just as well.
In fact, the simple method we
described in the December 2008
issue is quite valid. However, as
pointed out by a correspondent in
the Mailbag pages of the February
2009 issue, using measuring spoons
for a quantity of salt can be inaccurate and you are better off using
digital kitchen scales for making the
solution.
with the Foxtel digital decoders. The
standard IR receiver sold by Altronics
also is not the TSOP4136.
Farnell (www.farnellinone.com.
au) do sell the TSOP4136 and other
types of IR receivers. Either the TSOP
4138 which operates at 38kHz or the
TSOP1133 which operates at 33kHz
may be more suited to your DVD
recorder.
The Texas instruments TLC555 is
equivalent to the Intersil 7555 timer.
Both are the CMOS types and are suitable. The LMC555CN from National
Semiconductor is also suitable.
Secondhand batteries
are a risky proposition
After reading an article in your
magazine that stated it is better to plan
ahead when purchasing batteries for
solar systems, I have spent quite a lot
of time looking on eBay for some large
batteries. I have run into some 12V
150Ah SLA batteries and I wonder
what you think. They are secondhand,
siliconchip.com.au
eight years old, with a design life of 15
years. Do you think they are worth buying for a DIY solar system, considering
the price? (C. G., via email).
• You have no way of knowing what
you are getting when you buy secondhand batteries, from eBay or any other
source. Unless you could borrow them
and do some careful capacity tests over
several charge/discharge cycles you
could simply be buying some very
heavy garbage. The vendor may be
quite genuine but you have no way of
knowing that.
In any case, the vendor himself may
have no way of knowing or measuring
the performance of his batteries.
RF loop
explanation
I was wondering if someone might
be able to help me. When I look at
advertisements for SD and HD-STBs,
they sometimes refer to “RF-In” and
“RF Loop Out”.
What does “RF Loop Out” mean? Is
it just passing through the unprocessed
input signal to the output? Why don’t
any of the current breed of STB take
the digital RF input and then provide,
along with the other output formats,
an analog RF output signal? The lack
of such a signal means that another
device (ie, RCA-to-analog RF modulator) is required. (P. M., Karabar, NSW).
• The RF loop is exactly the same
as that on VCRs and DVD recorders,
where you have an “Antenna in” and
“Antenna out” socket to feed your TV.
One reason why STBs do not have
an analog RF output is that it would
defeat the purpose of the STB itself.
The picture quality available via the
composite video, component video
or HDMI outputs is much better than
Notes & Errata
6-Digit GPS Clock, May 2009: a
100µF 16V capacitor has been omitted from the circuit on page 22. It is
shown on the PC board overlay and
is adjacent to transistor Q14.
10A/230V Motor Speed Controller,
May 2009: the references to IC1a &
IC1b and to IC3a & IC3b in the text
should be swapped to agree with the
block diagram on page 39 and circuit
diagram on page 40 (the references to
IC3a & IC3b for the current monitoring circuit description are correct).
can be provided via a modulated RF
output.
Tank water
level display
I recently built the Tank Water Level
Display (SILICON CHIP, November &
December 2007) and the base station
to go with it. My problem is that they
refuse to talk to each other.
I have replaced both transmitters
and receivers and tested the new ones
that I put in (both were good). Now if
I connect a 4-ohm speaker to the data
and earth pins on the transmitter and
press the check button, the speaker
emits a healthy blurt, so it appears to
have a signal going to it.
I don’t get any noise if I connect the
speaker to the base station receiver
data and earth pins. Now bear in mind
that to test the transmitter and receiver
I just connected 5V to the “Ve” and
“Data” pins of the transmitter module and then monitored whether any
signal came out of the data pin on the
Preamplifier for Speed Controller,
Circuit Notebook, May 2009, page
35: the fourth paragraph in the righthand column makes reference to Q1
& Q2 forming a simple 2-transistor
amplifier. This should refer to Q1
& Q3.
2-Channel UHF Mains Switch, May
2009: on page 82, the +12V rail
supplying the junctions of the 47Ω
resistors and LED1 via Rs# should
come from the cathode of diode D1,
not the cathode of D2.
receiver module. I got a reading of 4.5V.
The only thing I can think of is that
the transmitter module might not be
getting any voltage before the data is
sent to it but I have no way of testing
this.
If you have any ideas, it would be
greatly appreciated. (B. W., via email).
• For the base station to receive data
from a tank meter, the base station
must be set to receive data from that
tank. For example, for tank 1 data, the
base station needs to be set to receive
tank 1. Setting up for this is described
in the base station article.
Similarly, the encode setting must
be the same for both the tank meter and
the base station in order to receive and
display the detected data.
Note that if the transmitter and
receiver are too close when testing
the units (less than about two metres
apart), the receiver will not detect
the data correctly. Note also that the
transmitter and receiver both require
an antenna as described to obtain adSC
equate transmission range.
WARNING!
SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage.
All such projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely.
Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles. When
working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with mains AC
voltages or high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages or other
high voltages, you are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims any liability
for damages should anyone be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any issue of SILICON
CHIP magazine.
Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON CHIP disclaims any liability for the
infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any
liability for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant government regulations and by-laws.
Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to
the Trade Practices Act 1974 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are applicable.
siliconchip.com.au
July 2009 99
ALL S ILICON C HIP SUBSCRIBERS – PRINT,
OR BOTH – AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR A
REFERENCE $ave 10%ONLINE
DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK OR PARTSHOP PURCHASES.
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% (Does not apply to subscriptions)
SILICON
For the latest titles and information, please refer to our website books page: www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/Books
PIC MICROCONTROLLERS: know it all
SELF ON AUDIO
Multiple authors $85.00
The best of subjects Newnes authors have written over the past few years,
combined in a one-stop maxi reference. Covers introduction to PICs and their
programming in Assembly, PICBASIC, MBASIC & C. 900+ pages.
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00*
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
See
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and
Review
April
advanced levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a
copy, along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback. 2011
PIC IN PRACTICE
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00*
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00*
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 467 pages in paperback.
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $95.00*
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students
and teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the
world of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introductory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00*
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition focuses entirely
on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and 12F675. 226 pages
in paperback.
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $85.00*
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00*
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
By Bruce Carter – 4th Edition 2013 $83.00*
This is the bible for anyone designing op amp circuits and you don't
have to be an engineer to get the most out of it. It is written in simple language
but gives lots of in-depth info, bridging the gap between the theoretical and the
practical. 281 pages,
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus
on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal for
engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics and
sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
by Sanjaya Maniktala, Published April 2012. $83.00
Thoroughly revised! The most comprehensive study available of theoretical and practical aspects of controlling and measuring
EMI in switching power supplies.
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting up
a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered
in this 176-page paperback book.
See
Review
Feb
2004
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00*
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
See
Review
March
2010
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
By Austin Hughes & Bill Drury - 4th edition 2013 $59.00*
This is a very easy to read book with very little mathematics or
formulas. It covers the basics of all the main motor types, DC
permanent magnet and wound field, AC induction and steppers and
gives a very good description of how speed control circuits work with these
motors. Soft covers, 444 pages.
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00*
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a
very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
AC MACHINES
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00*
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor
Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, singlephase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160
pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
e
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00* Review
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
286 pages in soft cover.
Feb
2003
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00*
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2007 $61.00*
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters and
receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
*NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order; NZ – $AU12.00 PER BOOK; REST OF WORLD $AU18.00 PER BOOK
To
Place
Your
Order:
INTERNET (24/7)
PAYPAL (24/7)
eMAIL (24/7)
www.siliconchip.
com.au/Shop/Books
Use your PayPal account
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
with order & credit card details
FAX (24/7)
MAIL (24/7)
Your order and card details to Your order to PO Box 139
Collaroy NSW 2097
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
with order & credit card details
You can also order and pay for books by cheque/money order (Mail Only). Make cheques payable to Silicon Chip Publications.
ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
ALL S ILICON C HIP SUBSCRIBERS – PRINT,
OR BOTH – AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR A
REFERENCE $ave 10%ONLINE
DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK OR PARTSHOP PURCHASES.
CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% (Does not apply to subscriptions)
SILICON
For the latest titles and information, please refer to our website books page: www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/Books
PIC MICROCONTROLLERS: know it all
SELF ON AUDIO
Multiple authors $85.00
The best of subjects Newnes authors have written over the past few years,
combined in a one-stop maxi reference. Covers introduction to PICs and their
programming in Assembly, PICBASIC, MBASIC & C. 900+ pages.
PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE
PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00*
A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE
See
series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and
Review
April
advanced levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a
copy, along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback. 2011
PIC IN PRACTICE
by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00*
Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students
and teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the
world of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback.
PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introductory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00*
A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students,
teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition focuses entirely
on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and 12F675. 226 pages
in paperback.
A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every
point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters,
hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 467 pages in paperback.
SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN
By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $95.00*
The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio
designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to
component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly
recommended. 558 pages in paperback.
AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK
by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $85.00*
"The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and
updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three
chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and
Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book
for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps,
you want this one! 463 pages in paperback.
DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES
by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00*
OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE
By Bruce Carter – 4th Edition 2013 $83.00*
This is the bible for anyone designing op amp circuits and you don't
have to be an engineer to get the most out of it. It is written in simple language
but gives lots of in-depth info, bridging the gap between the theoretical and the
practical. 281 pages,
PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS
IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00*
Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful
PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common,
real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes
source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback.
PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV
By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00
Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost
satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting up
a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered
in this 176-page paperback book.
NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY
By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00
It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is
ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP,
Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback.
RF CIRCUIT DESIGN
by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00*
The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important
that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use
there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a
very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback.
A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus
on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal for
engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics and
sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback.
See
Review
March
2010
See
Review
Feb
2004
SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z
by Sanjaya Maniktala, Published April 2012. $83.00
Thoroughly revised! The most comprehensive study available of theoretical and practical aspects of controlling and measuring
EMI in switching power supplies.
ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES
By Austin Hughes & Bill Drury - 4th edition 2013 $59.00*
This is a very easy to read book with very little mathematics or
formulas. It covers the basics of all the main motor types, DC
permanent magnet and wound field, AC induction and steppers and
gives a very good description of how speed control circuits work with these
motors. Soft covers, 444 pages.
AC MACHINES
By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00*
Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines,
NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor
Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, singlephase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160
pages in paperback.
PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES &
POWER ELECTRONICS
Se
e
by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00* Review
An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes
to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors.
286 pages in soft cover.
Feb
2003
BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE
PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK
by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2007 $61.00*
by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00*
by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00*
A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts.
Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines,
couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters and
receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback.
Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with
the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions
for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined
scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover.
*NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order; NZ – $AU12.00 PER BOOK; REST OF WORLD $AU18.00 PER BOOK
PAYPAL (24/7)
INTERNET (24/7)
MAIL (24/7)
PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri)
eMAIL (24/7)
FAX (24/7)
To
siliconchip.com.au
JCall
uly
2009 101
Use your PayPal account
www.siliconchip.
(02)
9939 3295 with
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your order and card details to Your order to PO Box 139
Place
com.au/Shop/Books silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Collaroy NSW 2097
with order & credit card details
with order & credit card details (02) 9939 2648 with all details
Your
You can also order and pay for books by cheque/money order (Mail Only). Make cheques payable to Silicon Chip Publications.
Order:
ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST
MARKET CENTRE
Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in SILICON CHIP
CLASSIFIED ADVERTISING RATES
Advertising rates for these pages: Classified ads: $29.50 (incl. GST) for up to 20
words plus 85 cents for each additional word. Display ads: $54.50 (incl. GST) per
column centimetre (max. 10cm). Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale.
To book your classified ad, email the text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and
include your name, address & credit card details, or fax (02) 9939 2648, or post
to Silicon Chip Classifieds, PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW, Australia 2097.
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
Looking for real
performance?
• Learn about
engine manage
ment systems
• Projects to
control nitrous,
fuel injection
and turbo boost
Intelligent
systems
TURBO BO
OST
engine
• Switch devices
according
to signal frequency, temp
erature & voltage
• Build test instruments to check fuel
injector duty cycle, fuel mixtures and
brake & temperature
From the publish
ers of
turbo timer
I SBN 09585229
9 78095
8
4-4
5229
46
$19.80 (inc GST) NZ
$22.00 (inc GST)
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
& nitrous fuel
controllers
How
management
works
Price: Aust. $A19.80 plus $A10 P&P
($A12 P&P NZ; $A18 P&P elsewhere) –
see the order form in this issue or www.
siliconchip.com.au for ordering details.
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
_____________ _____________ _____________ _____________ _____________
Enclosed is my cheque/money order for $__________ or please debit my
o
Visa Card o Master Card
Card No.
Signature_____________________________ Card expiry date______/______
Name _________________________________________________________
Street _________________________________________________________
Suburb/town ______________________________ Postcode______________
Phone:______________ Fax:______________ Email:___________________
102 Silicon Chip
FOR SALE
HP/Agilent 8920/8921/8924 “RF Tools”
PC Connectivity Software. Antenna/
filter tuning, cable fault location, RF
spectrum recording, signal-strength
logging, screen capture.
www.measurement.net.au
RCS RADIO/DESIGN is at 41 Arlewis
St, Chester Hill 2162, NSW Australia
and has all the published PC boards
from SC, EA, ETI, HE, AEM & others. Ph
(02) 9738 0330. sales<at>rcsradio.com.
au; www.rcsradio.com.au
AUSTRALIAN WASHING Machine
Repairs by L. Alford (+180 A4 page
book) $40 + p&p. 0419 350 106. www.
users.bigpond.com/lalf
LEDs! Nichia, Cree and other brand
name LEDs at excellent prices. LED
drivers, including ultra-reliable linear
driver options. Many other interesting
and hard-to-find electronic items! www.
ledsales.com.au
TECH REPAIRS SERVICE MANUALS
www.techrepairs.org – thousands of
siliconchip.com.au
C O N T R O L S
Tough times
demand innovative solutions!
ELNEC IC PROGRAMMERS
High quality
Realistic prices
Free software updates
Large range of adaptors
Windows 95/98/Me/NT/2k/XP
CLEVERSCOPE
USB OSCILLOSCOPES
SPK360
3/5/06used1:10
PM world-wide
Page 1
Made in Australia,
by OEMs
splat-sc.com
2 x 100MSa/s 10bit inputs + trigger
100MHz bandwidth
8 x digital inputs
4M samples/input
Sig-gen + spectrum analyser
Windows 98/Me/NT/2k/XP
IMAGECRAFT C COMPILERS
ANSI C compilers, Windows IDE
AVR, TMS430, ARM7/ARM9
68HC08, 68HC11, 68HC12
20 years experience!
HI-FISPEAKER REPAIRS
GRANTRONICS PTY LTD
www.grantronics.com.au
Specialising in UK, US and Danish brands.
Speakerbits are your vintage, rare and collectable speaker
repair experts. Foam surrounds, voice coils, complete
recone kits and more. Original OEM parts for Scan-Speak,
Dynaudio, Tannoy, JBL, ElectroVoice and others!
CIRCUIT
WIZARD
A revolutionary new
system that combines
circuit design, PCB design,
simulation & CAD/ CAM in
one complete package for
your pc.
om:
e demopftrs.com
e
r
f
a
d
a
Downloew-wave-conce
www.n
To see the
Standard
s between
difference
Ideal for Schools,
TAFEs, Hobbyists & Business
Circuit Wizard Standard – $225*
*inc GST &
Circuit Wizard Pro – $434*post
in Aust.
555Electronics
19 Kensington St, Clovelly Park,
SA 5042 Tel (08) 8277 8936
email: bwigley<at>senet.com.au
www.555electronics.com.au
VIDEO - AUDIO - PC
DVS5c & DVS5s
High Performance
Video / S-Video
and Audio Splitters
tel: 03 9647 7000 www.speakerbits.com
downloadable service manuals for all
brands, makes and models including
PDP, LCD, VCR, DVD, CTV, Vintage
Radio, Laptops, Monitors, Vacuum
Cleaners, Washing Machines, Dryers,
Fridges and many more. An absolute
must have website for any Tech!
PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any
format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame
Electronics Phone (02) 9593 1025.
sesame<at>sesame.com.au
www.sesame.com.au
POSITIONS VACANT
POSITION AVAILABLE for school leav
er / elect cert tech student / university
undergrad genuinely interested in electronic hardware development. Penrith,
Sydney. www.furzy.com
WANTED
CUSTOMERS: Truscotts Electronic
World – large range of semiconductors
and passive components for industry,
hobbyist and amateur projects including Drew Diamond. 27 The Mall, South
Croydon, Melbourne. (03) 9723 3860.
electronicworld<at>optusnet.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
atures’.
s click on ‘fe
nal version
& Professio
distribution amps - splitters
digital standards converters - tbc's
switchers - cables - adaptors
genlockers - scan converters
bulk vga cable - wallplates
SPK360
YOUR EXPERT SPEAKER REPAIR SPECIALISTS
NEW!
WANTED: EARLY HIFIs, AMPLIFIERS,
Speakers, Turntables, Valves, Books,
Quad, Leak, Pye, Lowther, Ortofon,
SME, Western Electric, Altec, Marantz,
McIntosh, Tannoy, Goodmans, Wharfedale, radio and wireless. Collector/
Hobbyist will pay cash. (07) 5471 1062.
johnmurt<at>highprofile.com.au
MD12 Media Distribution Amplifier
QUEST
®
Quest AV®
HQ VGA
Cables
KIT ASSEMBLY
KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY &
REPAIR:
* Australia & New Zealand;
* Small production runs.
Phone Keith 0409 662 794.
keith.rippon<at>gmail.com
VGA Splitter
VGS2
AWP1
A-V Wallplate
Come to the
specialists...
QUESTRONIX
®
Quest Electronics® Pty Limited abn 83 003 501 282 t/a Questronix
Products, Specials & Pricelist at www.questronix.com.au
fax (02) 4341 2795
phone (02) 4343 1970
email: questav<at>questronix.com.au
Issues Getting Dog-Eared?
Keep your copies safe with these
handy binders
Available Aust. only. Price: $A14.95 plus $10 p&p per
order (includes GST). Just fill in and mail the handy
order form in this issue; or fax (02) 9939 2648; or call
(02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number.
REAL
VALUE
AT
$14.95
PLUS
P&P
Buy five and get them postage free!
July 2009 103
Do you eat,
breathe
and sleep
TECHNOLOGY?
Opportunities exist for
experienced Sales Professionals
& Store Management across
Australia & NZ
Jaycar Electronics is a rapidly growing, Australian owned, international
retailer with more than 60 stores in Australia and New Zealand. Due
to our aggressive expansion program we are seeking dedicated sales
professionals to join our retail team to assist us in achieving our goals. We
pride ourselves on technical expertise from our staff. Do you think that the
following statements describe you? Please put a tick in the boxes that do:
Knowledge of core electronics, particularly at a component level
Retail experience, highly regarded
Assemble projects or kits yourself for your car, computer, audio etc
Have energy, enthusiasm and a personality that enjoys helping people
Opportunities for future advancement and development
Why not do something you love and get paid for it?
Please email us your applicaton & CV in PDF format, including location
preference. We offer a competitive salary, sales incentive and have a
generous staff purchase policy. Applications should be emailed to
jobs <at> jaycar.com.au
Jaycar Electronics is an Equal Opportunity Employer
& actively promotes staff from within the organisation.
into
RF?
DOWNLOAD OUR CATALOG at
www.iinet.net.au/~worcom
There’s something to suit every
radio frequency fan in the
SILICON CHIP reference bookshop
RF Circuit Design
– by Chris Bowick
A new edition of this classic RF
design text - tells how to design
and integrate RF components into
virtually any circuitry.
$
75
Practical RF H’book
– by Ian Hickman
A reference work for technicians,
engineers, students and the more
specialised enthusiast. Covers all
the key topics in RF that you
$
need to understand
90
Practical Guide To
Satellite TV
– by Garry Cratt
The reference written by an Aussie
for Aussie conditions.Everything
you need to know.
$
49
You’ll find many more technical
titles in the SILICON CHIP
reference bookshop – see
elsewhere in this issue
104 Silicon Chip
WORLDWIDE ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS
PO Box 631, Hillarys, WA 6923
Ph: (08) 9307 7305 Fax: (08) 9307 7309
Email: worcom<at>iinet.net.au
Silicon Chip
Circuit Ideas
Wanted
Do you have a good
circuit idea? If so,
sketch it out, write
a brief description
of its operation & send it to us.
Provided your idea is workable
& original, we’ll publish it in
Circuit Notebook & you’ll make
some money. We pay up to $100
for a good circuit idea or you
could win some test gear.
Silicon Chip Publications,
PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097.
Advertising Index
555 Electronics............................. 103
Agilent Technologies......................... 9
Alternative Technology Assoc......... 87
Altronics..................................... 74-77
Amalgen Technologies.................... 11
Amateur Scientist CDs.................... 69
Dick Smith Electronics............... 24-25
Emona Instruments......................... 10
Farnell............................................... 3
Furzy Electronics.......................... 103
Grantronics................................... 103
High Profile Communications........ 103
Instant PCBs................................. 103
Jaycar............................IFC,49-56,104
Keith Rippon................................. 103
LED Sales..................................... 102
Lindsay Alford Appliance Repairs. 102
Measurement Innovation.............. 102
MicroZed Computers...................... 41
Mornsun............................................ 8
Oatley Electronics......................... IBC
Ocean Controls............................... 43
Ozitronics........................................ 97
PCBCART......................................... 6
PCBCORE...................................... 11
Quest Electronics.......................... 102
RCS Radio.................................... 102
RF Modules...........................OBC,104
RMS Parts....................................... 23
Rohde & Schwarz............................. 5
Sesame Electronics...................... 103
Silicon Chip Binders...................... 103
Silicon Chip Bookshop........... 100-101
SC Performance Elect. For Cars... 103
Silicon Chip Order Form................. 37
Silicon Chip Subscriptions.............. 19
Siomar Battery Industries................. 7
Soundlabs Group.............................. 4
Speakerbits................................... 103
Splat Controls............................... 103
Switchmode Power Supplies........... 45
Tech Repairs................................. 102
Tekmark Australia............................. 6
Truscotts Electronic World............. 103
Wagner Electronics......................... 47
Worldwide Elect. Components...... 104
Xyber Data Recovery...................... 33
PC Boards
Printed circuit boards for SILICON CHIP
designs can be obtained from RCS
Radio Pty Ltd. Phone (02) 9738 0330.
Fax (02) 9738 0331.
siliconchip.com.au
K270 - TUBE PREAMPLIFIER KIT
This low cost tube
preamplifier
lets you
experience
tube
sound.
The K270 is based
on two low power consumption
Raytheon JAN6418 sub-miniature
pentodes. Kit is comes with PCB & onboard parts [K270]
K272 TUBE HEADPHONE AMPLIFIER KIT
Based on two low power
consumption Raytheon
JAN6418 subminiature pentodes.
Kit inc PCB & onboard parts [K270]
$29
K265 DIGITAL PANEL METER INTERFACE KIT
ring
onito
s
or m system
f
l
a
Ide power
r
sola
$16.50
one kit can power 2 meters.
K207A UP / DOWN INVERTER / LED DRIVER
WITH EXPERIMENTERS LED ARRAY PCBs.
This kit is designed
to up or down invert
to supply LEDs.
It is suited to our
10mm 1/4W LEDs.
$9.90
K269 MULTIPURPOSE HALL
EFFECT INTERFACE KIT
This Hall effect based kit should
be suitable for many
uses. The combination
can be used to
measure magnetic
field strength,
for shaft enA section
coders, to measure
of the PCB
rotational speed (RPM),
can be snapped
etc. The kit includes 2
off & wired to the
small rare earth
main PCB for remote use.
(Neodymium) magnets.
12VDC MOTOR AND SPEED
CONTROLLER KIT
PACKAGE DEAL
This package includes our
popular and powerful K252
speed controller kit (10-36V <at> 20A)
and a compact yet powerful DC motor.
This motor was designed for automotive
use. It has a connection on the rear for a
hose to apply positive pressure to stop
dust or water ingress.
Measures 60mm
Dia. X 110 overall. Special
introductory price of $29.00
[K252M2]
TEST EQUIPMENT (USED)
HP 8640A SIGNAL GENERATOR [1AZ79] $599, *** HP
8350B SWEEP OSCILLATOR + 86250D0 + 83525A
[1AZ86] $3,400, *** HP 3575A GAIN PHASE METER
1Hz - 13 MHz [1AZ83] $849, *** SWISS THOMMEN
3B4 GEODESIC SURVEYING ALTIMETER +/-2M
[1AZ91] $515.00, *** BWD MINI-LAB MODEL 603B
0.1Hz-1MHz FUNCTION GENERATOR [1AZ92]
$245.00, *** SOLARTRON SCHULMBERGER 4940 RF
MULTIPLEXER [1AZ99] $100.00, *** TRANSMISSION
IMPAIRMENT MEASURING SET [ZC0517] $200.00.
MORE ON OUR WEB SITE
(USED) 24V-700VA SINE WAVE INVERTER / UPS
Y
L
N
O
9
4
1
$
These UPS's are used but in excellent condition. They use a DB9 serial cable to connect to a computer. They have
genuine Sine Wave output, 4 IEC mains outlets & 1 IEC mains input. The front panel includes a LED bargraph
battery condition indicator. They use 2 standard 12V-7AHr batteries in series which may need to be replaced. Can
be used without a computer as they can be simply turned On or Off by pressing the front panel buttons. Software &
manuals can be downloaded from the manufactures web site. We supply the UPS and one IEC mains lead only. The
custom DB9 lead is available but not from us. However it is simple to make, see the connection diagram below.
[1UPS] $149.00. ABOVE UPS WITH NEW BATTERIES [1UPSBP] $179.00
BACK IN STOCK
K271 - 26" - 24V - 200W ELECTRIC
BIKE CONVERSION KIT
Detects pedalling and automatically assists the rider
and/or can be controlled with a conventional throttle.
Batteries not included.
PARTS LIST
1 X wheel & motor assy, 1 X controller, 1 X pedal,
sensor, 1 X pedal sensor disk, 1 X throttle, 2 X
handbrake levers
[K271] $249.00
PRECISION TRUE RMS AUTORANGING
5½ DIGIT MICROVOLT DMM
K
Unused Keithley
TOC
model 197 TRUE
ED S ICE
T
I
M
I
RMS Digital
RY L ANCE PR
M u l t i m e t e r. I t VE
R
includes a RF
CLEA
probe making it useful for 1mV-1/100V (with the divider
inc.) Includes an IEE-488 interface option and
analogue out. Inc. a Quick Reference Guide, Users &
Service manual for the DMM, and the IEEE Interface.
Accessories: Multimeter leads. SDRF-28 RF Probe and
tip set. SDFT-50 50ohm feed-through termination.
SDD-100 100:1 divider. [1AZ76] $479.00
MONO-CRYSTALLINE SOLAR PANELS
UNFRAMED 6W SOLAR PANELS
These panels are fully
sealed but have no
aluminum frame.
290 X 250 X 4mm
Power: 6W
O/circuit: 20.9V
S/circuit: 0.39A
Maximum: 0.36A
Max. Sys.: 1000V
[SP6UF] $50
BACK IN STOCK!
LARGE DC MOTORS
(GEARED & DIRECT DRIVE),
SPEED CONTROLLERS,
WHEELS, THROTTLES,
SPROCKETS AND CHAINS.
SEE OUR WEB SITE.
These panels are waterproof, aluminium framed and
covered with tempered glass. Connections are made to
the screw terminals that are inside the small box at the
rear of the panel.
8W SOLAR ARRAY
Includes two 4W 6V monocrystalline
solar panels.
Connect in parallel for a 6V - 8W array Or connect in
series for 12V - 8W output, Peak: 4W ea. Open Circuit:
10.6V Short Circuit: 0.5A Max.: 8.5V, Max.:0.47A,
254x294x23mm, 900g [2XSP4W6] $70.00
20W-12V MONOCRYSTALLINE SOLAR PANEL
Peak: 20W, Open
Circuit: 21.5V, Short
Circuit: 1.3A, Max.:
17.2V, Max.: 1.15A,
639 x 294 x 23mm
2.5kgs [SP20]
$155.00
100W SOLAR PANEL ARRAY & REGULATOR KIT
This 100W solar array inc. 5 X 20W-12V (As above)
monocrystalline solar panels, a 12V/24V regulator kit &
weatherproof box for the kit. [ARRAY] $660.00
Note: these panels may vary slightly from photographs.
www.oatleyelectronics.com Suppliers
of kits and surplus electronics to hobbyists, experimenters, industry & professionals.
Orders: Ph ( 02 ) 9584 3563, Fax 9584 3561, sales<at>oatleyelectronics.com, PO Box
89 Oatley
NSW 2223
July
2009 105
major credit cards accepted, Post & Pack typically $7 Prices subject to change without notice ACN 068 740 081 ABN18068 740 081
OR www.oatleye.com
siliconchip.com.au
SC_JUL_09
|